Als pdf oder txt herunterladen
Als pdf oder txt herunterladen
Sie sind auf Seite 1von 286

REPAIR MANUAL

MANUEL DE RÉPARATION
REPARATURANLEITUNG
MANUAL DE REPARACIÓN
MANUALE RIPARAZIONE

This document has been printed from my e doc

MANITOU BF
Head office: 430, Rue de l’Aubinière
44150 Ancenis - FRANCE
Share capital: 39,548,949 euros
857 802 508 RCS Nantes
Tel: +33 (0)2 40 09 10 11
www.manitou.com
La présente brochure n’est fournie qu’à titre consultatif, toute reproduction, copie, représentation, captation, cession, distribution, ou
autre, partiellement ou en totalité, sous quelque format que ce soit est interdite. Les schémas, les dessins, les vues, les commentaires
les indications, l’organisation même du document qui sont rapportés dans la présente documentation, sont la propriété intellectuelle
de MANITOU BF. Toute infraction à ce qui précède est susceptible d’entraîner des condamnations civiles et pénales. Les logos ainsi que
l’identité visuelle de l’entreprise sont la propriété de MANITOU BF et ne peuvent être utilisés sans autorisation exprès et formelle. Tous
droits réservés.

This manual is for information purposes only. Any reproduction, copy, representation, recording, transfer, distribution, or other, in part
or in whole, in any format is prohibited. The plans, designs, views, commentaries and instructions, even the document organization
that are found in this document, are the intellectual property of MANITOU BF. Any violation of the aforementioned may lead to civil
and criminal prosecution. The logos as well as the visual identity of the company are the property of MANITOU BF and may not be used
without express and formal authorization. All rights are reserved.

Die vorliegende Broschüre dient allein zur Beratung. Nachdruck, Fotokopieren, Vervielfältigung, Darstellung, Erfassung,
Überlassung, Verbreitung oder Sonstiges (ganz oder teilweise) in jeglicher Form sind verboten. Die Entwürfe, Zeichnungen,
Bilder, Darstellungen, Ansichten, Kommentare, Hinweise und der Aufbau der Druckschrift selbst, die in der vorliegenden
Dokumentation enthalten sind, sind geistiges Eigentum von MANITOU BF. Alle Verstöße gegen das Vorstehende können zu straf-
oder zivilrechtlicher Verfolgung führen. Die Logos und Markenzeichen sowie Unternehmens- und Produktbezeichnungen sind
Eigentum von MANITOU BF und dürfen ohne ausdrückliche Genehmigung nicht verwendet werden. Alle Rechte vorbehalten.

Este folleto se ofrece a título meramente informativo y queda prohibida su reproducción, copia, representación, captación, cesión,
distribución y demás, parcial o total, en el formato que sea. Los esquemas, dibujos, vistas, comentarios, indicaciones, la organización
misma del documento aportado en esta documentación son propiedad intelectual de MANITOU BF. Cualquier infracción a lo
antedicho puede acarrear condenas civiles y penales. Los logotipos y la identidad visual de la empresa son propiedad de MANITOU
BF y no pueden utilizarse sin su autorización expresa y formaL. Reservados todos los derechos.

Il presente manuale è fornito esclusivamente a titolo di consultazione; è vietata qualsiasi riproduzione, copia, rappresentazione,
acquisizione, cessione, distribuzione o altro, parziale o totale, e in qualsivoglia formato. Gli schemi, i disegni, le viste, i commenti,
le indicazioni e l’organizzazione stessa del documento, riportati nella presente documentazione, sono proprietà intellettuale
di MANITOU BF. Qualsiasi violazione a quanto riportato sopra è passibile di condanna civile e penale. I loghi e l’identità visiva
dell’azienda sono di proprietà di MANITOU BF e non possono essere utilizzati senza previa autorizzazione espressa e formale. Tutti i
diritti sono riservati.
COMPLET REPAIR MANUAL 120 AETJL 150 AETJC - AETJ 43150 AETJC 3D - AETJ 43
3D 150 AETJL170 AETJL - AETJ 49 1

GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS AND SAFETY NOTICE


GROUP 00 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 3-1

AXLE ASSEMBLY - AXLE


GROUP 30 AXLE 4-1

FRONT ARMS
GROUP 55 JIB - BASKET 5-1

HYDRAULIC
GROUP 70 HYDRAULIC 6-1

ELECTRICITY
GROUP 80 ELECTRICITY 7-1
547379EN (08/03/2017)

120 AETJL
150 AETJC - AETJ 43
150 AETJC 3D - AETJ 43 3D
150 AETJL
170 AETJL - AETJ 49

REPAIR MANUAL
547379EN
2

DATE OF ISSUE OBSERVATION

07/01/2005 - 1st ISSUE

12/01/2005 Addition of platforms: 120 AETJL, 150 AETJ COMPACT


Change of machine names:
150 AETJ became 150 AETJL, 170 AETJ became AETJL

01/01/2008 Updated: GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY

04/01/2008 Updated:
REAR AXLE - OPERATION IN FREEWHEEL MODE
TELESCOPE PADS - REMOVAL
HYDRAULIC
ELECTRICITY

03/08/2017 Updated:
Addition of machines 150 AETJC 3D, AETJ 43, AETJ 43 3D, AETJ 49
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY
HYDRAULIC
ELECTRICITY

MANITOU BF S.A Limited liability company with a Board of Directors.


Head office: 430, Rue de l’Aubinière - 44150 Ancenis - FRANCE
Share capital: 39,548,949 euros
857 802 508 RCS Nantes
Tel: +33 (0)2 40 09 10 11
www.manitou.com

This manual is for information purposes only. Any reproduction, copy, representation, recording, transfer, distribution, or other,
in part or in whole, in any format is prohibited. The plans, designs, views, commentaries and instructions, even the document
organization that are found in this document, are the intellectual property of MANITOU BF. Any violation of the aforementioned
may lead to civil and criminal prosecution. The logos as well as the visual identity of the company are the property of MANITOU-BF
and may not be used without express and formal authorization. All rights are reserved.
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY

00
ENGINE

10
TRANSMISSION

20
AXLE

30
BRAKE

40
JIB - BASKET

55
HYDRAULIC

70
ELECTRICITY
80
DRIVER’S CAB
85

FRAME - BODY
90
110

OPTIONS - ATTACHMENTS
547379EN
4 (08/03/2017)

INTERACTIVE REPAIR MANUAL


547379EN
(08/03/2017) 5

GLOSSARY
AOC Ammonia Oxidation Catalysts: elimination by oxidation of the excess ammonia
(NH3) from exhaust gases having undergone selective catalytic reduction
(SCR) of nitrogen oxides (NOx), by injection of ammonia.

APC After Power Contact: post-ignition current.

BMEP Bloc Manipulateur ÉlectroProportionnel : Controls the hydraulic movements


of: lowering, lifting, tilting and digging by electronic sensors.

CAN Controller Area Network: control communication network for communication


between systems (J1939, Open, etc.).

CO Carbon Monoxide: colourless, odourless and highly toxic gas.

CVT Continuous Variable Transmission.

DEF Diesel Exhaust Fluid: aqueous solution consisting of 32,5% urea and 67,5%
demineralised water, used to transform 85% of pollutants (NOx) into water
vapour (H2O) and harmless nitrogen (N2).

DOC Diesel Oxide Catalyst: part of the exhaust gas filter or a post-treatment device
used to reduce polluting emissions (HC and CO).

DSB Double switch Board: smart switch board connected to a LIN network via a
wiring harness.

DPF (=FAP) Diesel Particulate Filter (= Filtre À Particule) : device designed to remove diesel
particulate matter or soot from the exhaust gas of a diesel engine.

DTC Data Trouble Code: standard fault codes

ECU Electronic Control Unit or Engine Control Unit: machine or engine control
computer.

FMI Failure Mode Identifier: fault code & description:


0 – The data is valid but the data is above the normal operational range.
1 – The data is valid but the data is below the normal operational range.
2 – The data is erratic, intermittent, or incorrect.
3 – The voltage is above normal or the voltage is shorted high.
4 – The voltage is below normal or the voltage is shorted low.
5 – The current is below normal or the circuit is open.
6 – The current is above normal or the circuit is grounded.
7 – The mechanical system is not responding properly.
8 – There is an abnormal frequency, an abnormal pulse width, or an abnormal
time period.
9 – There has been an abnormal update.
10 – There is an abnormal rate of change.
11 – The failure mode is not identifiable.
12 – The device or the component is damaged.
13 – The device requires calibration.
15 – The signal from the device is high (least severe).
547379EN
6 (08/03/2017)

FMI 16 – The signal from the device is high (moderate severity) .


17 – The signal from the device is low (least severe) .
18 – The signal from the device is low (moderate severity) .
19 – There is an error in the data from the device.
20 – There is an error in the data from the device (high).
21 – There is an error in the data from the device (low).
31 – The device has failed and the engine has shutdown.

HC Hydrocarbon: organic compound consisting exclusively of carbon (C) and


hydrogen (H) atoms.

HS High Side: power side power supply.

HVAC Heating, Fan and Air-Conditioning: in-cab heating, ventilation and air-
conditioning block.

IHM Interface Homme Machine : Human-Machine Interface, dashboard screens.

JSM Joystick Switch & Move: joystick serving to perform all telescope movements,
as well as to control machine forward and reverse movements with one hand.

LIN Local Interconnect Network.

LLMI Limit Load Moment Indicator: strain gauge ensuring machine stability.

LS Low Side: ground side power supply.

LSU Load Sensing Ultra: hydraulic load detection.

NC (=NF) Normally Closed (= Normalement Fermé) : normally closed contact.

NO Normally Open: normally open contact.

NOx Nitrogen Oxide: regulated air pollutants.

PAD Plug And Diag: machine diagnostic touchscreen tablet.

PS / PS+ Power Shift: semi-automatic gear box.


Power Shift +: automatic gear box from 3rd gear and higher.

PWM
Pulse Width Modulation: Modulation of the pulse
width of a fixed-frequency digital electronic signal
synthesising intermediate analog signals over a
certain duration.

SAHR Spring Applied Hydraulically Released: method of blocking the parking brake
(negative brake).

SCR Selective Catalytic Reduction: reduction of nitrogen oxides (NOx) emitted by


internal combustion engines.

SPU Safety Power Unit: machine controller.

USB Universal Serial Bus.


GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY

00
TABLE OF CONTENTS

00.1 GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS AND SAFETY NOTICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

00.1.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

00.1.2 SERVICING POSITION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

00.1.3 EXPLANATION OF SYMBOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9

00.1.4 SERVICING RULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

00.2 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

00.2.1 CHARACTERISTICS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

00.2.2 LUBRICANTS AND FUEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

00.2.3 DIMENSIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14

DIMENSIONS 120AETJL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14

DIMENSIONS 150AETJC - AETJ 43 - AETJC 43 3D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16

DIMENSIONS 150AETJL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18

DIMENSIONS 170AETJL - 49 AETJC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

00.2.4 LOCATION OF NAME AND IDENTIFICATION PLATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

ACCESS PLATFORM MANUFACTURER’S PLATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

LOCATION OF MANUFACTURER'S PLATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

120 AETJ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

00.3 GENERAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23

00.3.1 STANDARD TIGHTENING TORQUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23

00.3.2 METRIC - IMPERIAL UNIT CONVERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24


547379EN
8 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY

00.1 GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS AND SAFETY NOTICE

00.1.1 INTRODUCTION

This chapter deals with the general instructions and safety notice during inspection and maintenance
work.
Other instructions and warnings are indicated in each chapter concerned.

In order to reduce accident risks, make sure to:

– Follow the instructions in the truck operating and maintenance manual.


⇒ This manual should be found in all trucks.
– Please follow all safety instructions.
– Use the appropriate tools for any work to be performed.
– Use original Manitou spare parts.

Any non-compliance increases the risk of accidents occurring which may lead to causing grievous bodily
harm and even death.

An efficient, dependable and profitable combination will be formed if the operator follows the safety
manual correctly and the machine is serviced properly.
00.1.2 SERVICING POSITION

Before any intervention:

1 - Place the machine on a flat surface and chock the wheels.


2 - Turn off the engine and remove the ignition key.
3 - Let the machine cool down.
4 - Take all the pressure out of the circuits concerned.
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 9

00
00.1.3 EXPLANATION OF SYMBOLS

The symbols shown below are used to warn of potential hazards as well as to provide useful information
concerning a procedure.

SYMBOLE OBSERVATION

Indicates an imminent hazardous situation which, if not avoided


DANGER will result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided,


WARNING may result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided,


CAUTION may result in minor injury or damage to property. It is also used to
warn users of unsafe practices.

TIP Indicates a tip to facilitate the performance of a procedure.

Indicates a message to draw attention to important information


PROTECT THE ENVIRONMENT regarding environmental protection.

SPECIFIC TOOLING Indicates special tools for performing a task.

4 "SEE": Indicates a cross-reference to a manual.

5 “SEE”: Indicates a cross-reference to a page.

0 “SEE”: Indicates a cross-reference to a picture.

"WEIGHT": Indicates the weight of an item.


3 (E.g.: it helps to anticipate an action linked to a person's health or the
choice of lifting equipment)

2 "TIGHTENING TORQUE": Indicates the value of tightening torque


to be applied.

1 "OPTION": Indicates the presence of an option.

The manufacturer cannot predict all possible risky situations. Consequently, the safety instructions
given in the manual are not exhaustive.
At any time, as an operator, you must consider, within reason, the possible risk to yourself, to others
or to the lift truck itself when you repair, service or drive it.

Manitou cannot be held responsible for the use of any lifting devices, tools or operating methods other
than those specified.
547379EN
10 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

00.1.4 SERVICING RULES

Do not carry out any work on the machine unless you have
followed a suitable training course and have the knowledge
required for it.

4 Make sure you have taken into consideration all the indicator
plates on the machine and in the instruction manual.

PRÉCAUTION
Be careful not to burn yourself when touching hot liquids or parts when
operations have to be done before the machine has had time to cool down.

AVERTISSEMENT
1 Before carrying out any operation on an electrically powered component,
activate the battery cut-off.
2
PRÉCAUTION
Press the battery switch at least 30 seconds after disconnecting the electrical
contact with the ignition key.

AVERTISSEMENT
If the telehandler does not have a battery isolating switch, disconnect the
battery terminals then gather them.

PRÉCAUTION
ECU
Before carrying out any welding operations, think of disconnecting computers.

PRÉCAUTION

A machine operating in a contaminated environment should be specifically


equipped. Moreover, local safety notices deal with maintenance and repair
work on such machines.
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 11

00
AVERTISSEMENT
Never step on a part of the machine that has not been designed for it.

AVERTISSEMENT
Never wear clothes, jewelry or objects that could get caught during work and
cause accidents.

Always wear protection glasses, gloves, safety shoes as well as any other
protection required for the work to be carried out.

DANGER
When carrying out maintenance
operations near a mobile object,
make sure it is securitized.

PROTÉGER L’ENVIRONNEMENT

When changing, or draining oils or fuel, or any other operation with liquids,
solids, gases that are harmful to the environment, make sure the necessary
precautions are taken to avoid contaminating the environment.
547379EN
12 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DANGER

When lifting or shoring a component of the machine, make sure the equipment
used is suitable for at least the load for which it is subjected by the component
and that it meets the national standards for lifting devices.

When using a jack, make sure it is used on a flat, uniform surface, is sturdy
enough to support the load, that its lifting capacity is sufficient and that it is
correctly placed and positioned under the machine.

PRÉCAUTION

Make sure no object or tool which could cause an accident is left in the machine.

AVERTISSEMENT
Never control any leaks using a hand.

max.

min.
PRÉCAUTION
MAX Never adjust a component to over the maximum capacity indicated by the
manufacturer.

MIN
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 13

00
00.2 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS

00.2.1 CHARACTERISTICS
Designation 120 AETJL 150 AETJC 150 AETJC 3D 150 AETJL 170 AETJL AETJ 43 AETJ 43 3D AETJ 49
5050 kg 6700 kg 6760 kg 5910 kg 6910 kg 7100 kg 7160 kg 7105 kg
Unladen weight of carriage
(11,133 lbs) (14,771 lbs) (14,904 lbs) (13,030 lbs) (15,234 lbs) (15,653 lbs) (15,785 lbs) (15,684 lbs)
1185 kg 1465 kg 1465 kg 1240 kg 1534 kg 1555 kg
FRONT - -
Unladen pneumatic (2,613 lbs) (3,230 lbs) (3,230 lbs) (2,734 lbs) (3,389 lbs) (3,428 lbs)
load 1340 kg 1885 kg 1885 kg 1715 kg 1921 kg 1992.5 kg
REAR - -
(2,954 lbs) (4,156 lbs) (4,156 lbs) (3,781 lbs) (4,325 lbs) (4,393 lbs)
Nominal capacity 200 kg 200 kg 200 kg 230 kg 200 kg 227 kg 227 kg 227 kg
(2 people) (441 lbs) (441 lbs) (441 lbs) (507 lbs) (441 lbs) (500 lbs) (500 lbs) (500 lbs)

00.2.2 LUBRICANTS AND FUEL

Designation Type Quantity


18 ℓ
Hydraulic tank MANITOU ISO VG 46 Hydraulic oil
(4.76 US gallons)
0.8 ℓ
Wheel motor (each) (0.21 US gallons)
SHELL SPIRAX A90 oil
Turret rotation motor 1.5 ℓ
(0.40 US gallons)
General greasing SHELL RETINAX HD grease -
Greasing of turret crown of
Grease SHELL ALVANIA EP LF 2 -
bearing track
Lubrication of turret crown
SHELL MALLEUS GL 205 oil -
gear teeth
547379EN
14 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

00.2.3 DIMENSIONS
DIMENSIONS 120AETJL

mm ft-in
A 5520 18-1.3
A1 3930 12-10.7
B 2000 6-6.7 F
C 1995 6-6.5 H
C1 2210 7-3.0
D 1500 4-11.1
E 153 0-6.0
F 2640 8-8.0
G 1870 6-1.6
H 3960 12-11.9
I 4520 14-9.9
G

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 15

00
mm ft-in mm ft-in

G1 2350 7-8.5 H1 9950 32-7.7

G2 3105 10-2.2 H2 8795 28-10.3

G3 6370 20-10.8 H3 4775 15-8.0

G4 5640 18-6.0 H4 545 1-9.5

3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

13

12
G1
11

10
H1

G2
H2

G3
H3

G4 2

1
H4

3 2 2 3 4 5 6 7
547379EN
16 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DIMENSIONS 150AETJC - AETJ 43 - AETJC 43 3D

mm ft-in
A 6050 19-10.2
A1 4400 14-5.2
B 2000 6-6.7
C 1965 6-5.4
C1 2080 6-9.9 F
D 1500 4-11.1 H
E 143 0-5.6
F 2640 8-7.9
G 1870 6-1.6
H 3960 12-11.9
I 4820 15-9.7

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 17

00
mm ft-in mm ft-in

G1 2665 8-8.9 H1 12985 42-7.2

G2 3425 11-2.8 H2 11835 38-9.9

G3 7105 23-3.7 H3 7165 23-6.1

G4 6300 20-8.0 H4 235 0-9.2

3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

16

15

G1
14

13
H1

12

G2
H2

11

10

7
G3
H3

2
G4

1
H4

3 2 2 3 7 8 9
547379EN
18 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DIMENSIONS 150AETJL

mm ft-in
A 5960 19-6.6
A1 4400 14-5.2
B 2000 6-6.7
C 1970 6-5.5
C1 2080 6-9.9
F H
D 1750 5-8.9
E 143 0-5.6
F 2880 9-5.4
G 1970 6-5.6
H 4270 14-0.1
I 4890 16-0.5

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 19

00
mm ft-in mm ft-in

G1 2660 8-8.7 H1 13275 43-6.6

G2 3420 11-2.6 H2 12120 39-9.1

G3 7310 23-11.8 H3 7165 23-6.1

G4 6500 21-3.9 H4 205 0-8.1

3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

16

15
G1

14

13
H1

12

G2
H2

11

10

7
G3
H3

2
G4

1
H4

3 2 2 3 5 8 9
547379EN
20 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DIMENSIONS 170AETJL - 49 AETJC

mm ft-in
A 6840 22-5.3
F H
A1 5120 16-9.6
B 2000 6-6.7
C 1970 6-5.6
C1 2040 6-8.3
D 1750 5-8.9
E 140 0-5.5
F 2890 9-5.8
G 2005 6-6.9
H 4300 14-1.3 G
I 5600 18-4.5

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 21

00
mm ft-in
G1 2840 9-3.8
G2 3600 11-9.7
G3 8930 29-3.6
G4 8130 26-8.1
H1 14905 48-10.8
H2 13750 45-1.3
H3 7160 23-5.9
H4 270 0-10.6 

             


































       
547379EN
22 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

GENERAL LOCATION
00.2.4 LOCATION OF NAME AND IDENTIFICATION PLATE
As our policy is one of constant improvement of our products, our range of access platforms may undergo
certain modifications, without obligation for us to advise our customers.
When you order parts, or when you require any technical information, always specify:
NOTE: For the owner's convenience, it is recommended that a note of these numbers is made in the
spaces provided, at the time of the delivery of the access platform.
1-1
ACCESS PLATFORM MANUFACTURER’S PLATE

Type:
Serial no.:
Year of manufacture:

1-2
LOCATION OF MANUFACTURER'S PLATE 120 AETJ
The manufacturer's plate is fitted on the inside right panel of the
turret.

1-3
LOCATION OF MANUFACTURER'S PLATE
150 AETJC - AETJ43 - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ43 3D
150 AETJL - AETJ49
170 AETJ L

The manufacturer's plate is fitted on the left rear side of the chassis.
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 23

00
00.3 GENERAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT

b
00.3.1 STANDARD
STANDARD TIGHTENING
TIGHTENING TORQUESTORQUES
(N.m & lb-in))
Standard tightening torques
To be used. unless otherwise indicated in the removal or refit operations.
SCREW / NUT ASSEMBLY
- with hexagon head screws without flanges ou cylinder head hexagon socket screws.
- for dry-fitted zinc-plated fasteners and for torque tools having a ± 20 % class C tightening torque
accuracy (equivalent to pneumatic screwdrivers).
1 - NF E 25-030-1 :
Ø x “coarse” pitch Grade 8.8 Grade 10.9 Ø x “fine” pitch Grade 8.8 Grade 10.9
N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in
M6 x 1 8.2 72.57 12.1 107 - - -
M8 x 1.25 20 177 30 265 M8 x 1 22 195 32 283
M10 x 1.5 40 354 59 522 M10 x 1.25 (x 1) 43 (46) 380 (407) 63 (68) 558 (602)
M12 x 1.75 69 611 102 903 M12 x 1.5 (x 1.25) 74 (78) 655 (690) 108 (115) 956
M14 x 2 111 982 163 1443 M14 x 1.5 123 1088 181 1602
M16 x 2 175 1549 256 2266 M16 x 1.5 190 168 279 2470
M18 x 2.5 240 2124 352 3115 M18 x 1.5 279 2469 410 3629
M20 x 2.5 341 3018 501 4434 M20 x 1.5 391 3460 574 5080
M22 x 2.5 470 4160 691 6116 M22 x 1.5 531 4700 780 6903
M24 x 3 588 5204 864 7647 M24 x 2 659 5833 967 8559
M27 x 3 874 7735 1284 11364 M27 x 2 965 8541 1418 12550
M30 x 3.5 1181 10453 1735 15356 M30 x 2 1351 11957 1984 17560
M33 x 3.5 1614 14285 2371 20985 M33 x 2 1821 16117 2674 23667

b
M36 x 4 2068 18303 3037 26880 - - -

For hexagon screws with flanges (NF E 25-030-1) :


Apply an increased torque of +10%.

b Where washers are used. the following coefficient is to be applied (FD E 25-502) :
- Plate : +0% - Spring (or Grower) washer without jaws (W) : +10%
- Smooth tapered washer (CL): +5% - Conical. internal teeth (CDJ-JZC) : +15%.
2 - With marking :

4 5 6 7 8
4T 6T 8T
------------ ------------ ------------

5T
(N.m)
7T
(N.m)
11
(flange : 4.8T) (flange : 6.8T) (flange : 8.8T) (flange : 10.9T) (flange : 11.9T)
Ø x Pitch N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in
5.4 48 7.8 69 12 106
M6 x 1 6.5 57.5 11 97 (15.5) (137.2) (17.5) (155)
(5.5) (49) (7.5) (66) (12) (106)
13 115 19 168 29 257
M8 x 1.25 16 142 25 221 (38) (336) (42) (372)
(13) (115) (19) (168) (29) (257)
25 221 39 345 61 540
M10 x 1.25 32 283 52 460 (80) (708) (89) (788)
(27) (239) (39) (345) (61) (540)
47 416 72 637 108 956
M12 x 1.25 59 522 95 841 (145) (1283) (160) (1416)
(50) (443) (71) (628) (110) (974)
75 664 108 956 172 1522
M14 x 1.5 91 805 147 1301 (230) (2036) (260) (2301)
(78) (690) (110) (974) (175) (1549)

b
113 1000 172 1522 265 2345
M16 x 1.5 137 1213 226 2000 (360) (3186) (400) (3540)
(120) (1062) (170) (1504) (270) (2390)

use the upper class where spring (or Grower) washers are used.
547379EN
24 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

00.3.2 METRIC - IMPERIAL UNIT CONVERSION


RULES
-The tolerance has the same unit as the value and is not a percentage :
Example : 120 ± 12 Ω , not 120 ± 10 %.
-The unit is separated from the value by a space and placed after the tolerance :
Example: 120 Ω ou 120 ± 12 Ω except for angle degrees : 40° ou 40 ± 3°.
-The conversion of some marks is not possible :
Example: thread of a screw : M12x1.75.
-Use decimals to convert precise values :
Example: 190 mm = 7.48 in.
-Write lengths in feet-inches format:
Example: 20 m = 65 ft 7.4 in or in a table 20 (m) = 65-7.4 (ft-in).
CONVERSION COEFFICIENTS:
Metric Unit (S.I) Coefficient Imperial Unit US
° (angle degree) x 1 = ° (angle degree)
°C (Celsius degree) x 1.8 + 32 = °F (Fahrenheit degree)
cv (cheval vapeur) x 0.9859 = hp (horsepower)
bar (bar) x 14.51 = psi (pound-force/square inch)
g (gram) x 0.0353 = oz av (ounce avoirdupois) (oz : lat. onza)
Hz (Hertz) x 1 = Hz (Hertz)
kg (kilogram) x 2.2046 = lb (pound) (lat . libra)
kg (kilogram) x 35.274 = oz av (ounce avoirdupois) (oz : lat. onza)
km/h (kilometer per hour) x 0.6214 = mph (miles per hour)
kW (kilowatt) x 1.34048 = hp (horsepower)
ℓ (liter) x 0.2642 = gal US (US gallon)
ℓ (liter) x 1.0567 = qt US (quart US gallon)
m (meter) x 3.2808 = ft (foot)
m (meter) x 39.37 = in (inch)
min (minute) x 1 = min (minute)
mℓ (milliliter) x 0.0338 = fl oz (fluid ounce) (fl : fluid, oz : lat. onza)
mm (millimeter) x 0.03937 = in (inch)
µm (micrometer) x 0.03937 = mil (thousands of an inch)
N (Newton) x 0.2248 = lbf (pound-force) (lb : lat. libra, f : force)
N.m (Newton meter) x 0.7376 = ft-lb (pound-force-foot) (ft : foot, lb : lat. libra)
N.m (Newton meter) x 8.8507 = lb-in (pound-force-inch) (lb : lat. libra, in : inch)
s (second of time) x 1 = s (second of time)
rad/s (radian/second) x 9.5493 = rpm (revolution per minute)
t (metric ton) x 2204.62 = lb (pound) (lat. libra)
tr/min (tour per minute) x 1 = rpm (revolution per minute)
Ω (Ohm) x 1 = Ω (Ohm)
Other unit conversions Coefficient
ft (foot) x 12 = in (inch)
lb (pound) (lat . libra) x 16 = oz av (ounce avoirdupois)
m (meter) x 1000 = mm (millimeter)
µm (micrometer) x 0.001 = mm (millimeter)
t (metric ton) x 1000 = kg (kilogram)
° (angle degree) x 0.01745 = rad (radian)
Abbreviation
lat: Latin
gr: Greek
AXLE

TABLE OF CONTENTS

30.1 CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27

30.1.1 REAR AXLE - OPERATION IN FREEWHEEL MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27

30
547379EN
26 AXLE 30 (08/03/2017)
30
547379EN
30 (08/03/2017) AXLE 27

AXLE

30.1 CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS

30.1.1 REAR AXLE - OPERATION IN FREEWHEEL MODE


DANGER
In order to operate the access platform in freewheel mode, it should not be subjected to translational
constraints resulting from a slope.
When the access platform is in the freewheel mode, it can move freely: fit wedges to immobilize the wheels.

CAUTION

30
If the access platform needs to be towed, this operation should only be carried out:
- Over short distances.
- Necessarily by a machine that has high braking power in order to hold it steady, and at a slow speed.
- By means of a connecting bar between the two machines.

30 - 4 - IF POSSIBLE, lift the rear of the platform (1, 030 - 4).

33 120 AETJL : 2680 kg (5908 lbs)


2
33 150 AETJC : 3770 kg (8311 lbs)
33 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D : 3375 kg (7441 lbs)
33 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 3842 kg (8470 lbs)
33 AETJ43 - AETJ43 3D : 3775 kg (8322 lbs)

- Locate the screws (2, 030 - 4).


2
1

30 - 5 - Unscrew these screws according to the model of your platform,


030 - 5) by 22 mm (0.87 in), up to the hard spot and without forcing:
150 N.m RISK OF BREAKAGE.
22 Maximum loosening torque 20 N.m (177 lb-in).
2 - Set the platform down.
20 N.m - The machine can now be towed.
22 mm RESETTING
1
- Raise the rear of the platform.
- Turn the wheels from left to right and reset the gears by re-
tightening the screws (2, 030 - 5):
22 Maximum tightening torque for rear wheel 150 N.m (1327.6  lb-in)

15 daNm
JIB - BASKET

TABLE OF CONTENTS

55.1 JIB - BASKET CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2 JIB - BASKET REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2.1 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2.2 REMOVAL OF REAR PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2.3 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPE MOVING TUBE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32

55
547379EN
30 JIB - BASKET 55 (08/03/2017)
55
547379EN
55 (08/03/2017) JIB - BASKET 31

JIB - BASKET

55.1 JIB - BASKET CONTROLS

55.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE


CLEARANCE between moving tube and arm of telescope
Lateral 0.5 mm (0.02 in)
Upper 0.5 mm (0.02 in)

If necessary, add the adjustment plates if necessary (see parts catalogs).

55.2 JIB - BASKET REMOVAL

55.2.1 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER


55 - 6 Remove the telescopic cylinder (6TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL,
5 63)
Remove and replace the pads (1, 055 - 6) (see parts catalog).

55
1

55.2.2 REMOVAL OF REAR PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER


55 - 7 - Remove the telescopic cylinder (6TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL,
5 63).

1
- Release the pads (1, 055 - 7) by slightly raising the basket.

- Remove the pads (1, 055 - 7), pay attention to the position and
number of adjustment plates.

- Get new pads (see parts catalog)


1 - Replace the pads and adjustment plates, then check the clearance
(655.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE, 5 31).
547379EN
32 JIB - BASKET 55 (08/03/2017)

55.2.3 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPE MOVING TUBE


55 - 8
- Remove the telescopic cylinder (6TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL,
5 63).
1
- Remove the flexible guide fasteners on the moving tube (1, 055 - 8).

1 - Sling the basket/jib/hinge assembly (2, 055 - 8):


2 33 without steering actuator (3D - JIB) 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 with steering actuator (3D - JIB) 267 kg (589 lbs)

3 - Remove the axles (3, 055 - 8) then remove the basket/jib/hinge


assembly nearby to avoid damaging the hydraulic hoses and
3
wiring harnesses.

55 - 9 - Release the pads of the telescope jib by gently releasing the


moving tube (1, 055 - 9).

1 2 - Remove the pads (2, 055 - 9) of the telescope jib, pay attention to
the position and number of adjustment plates.
55

- Remove the moving tube by allowing it to slide towards the rear:


33 120 AETJL : 102 kg (225 lbs)
2 33 150 AETJC et 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ43 - AETJ43 3D:
116 kg (256 lbs)
33 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 148 kg (326 lbs)

55 - 10 - Remove the pads (1, 055 - 10), pay attention to the position and
1
number of adjustment plates.

- Get new pads (see parts catalog).

- Fit the pads and adjustment plates, then check the clearance
(655.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE, 5 31).
1

1
HYDRAULIC

TABLE OF CONTENTS

70.1 HYDRAULIC SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35


70.1.1 679449 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35

70.1.2 685268 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39

70.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43

70.2.1 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE CHASSIS - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43

70.2.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE TURRET - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44

70.2.3 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE JIB - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45

70.3 HYDRAULIC CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

70.3.1 MAIN CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

70.3.2 STEERING, BASKET/TURRET ROTATION CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

70.3.3 BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48


PRESSURE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48

70.3.4 TELESCOPIC CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49


PRESSURE REDUCER SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49

70.3.5 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50


DECOMPRESSION OF THE CIRCUIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50

70
VALVE A ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50

VALVE B ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51

70.3.6 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PROBLEM SOLVING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52


TEST PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52

ANALYSIS OF RESULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53

70.3.7 TURRET ROTATION MOTOR - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54

70.3.8 ELECTRIC PUMP - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55

70.3.9 REDUCING GEARS/WHEEL BRAKES - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56

70.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57

DISTRIBUTOR - DETAILS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59

70.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

STEERING CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

REFIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

ARM 1/2 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61

ARM 3 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62

TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63

COMPENSATION/TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64

JIB CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66

BASKET ROTATION CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67

ROTATION CYLINDER (3D - JIB) - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68


547379EN
34 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

LINKS TO REPAIR MANUALS:

MANUAL REFERENCE
DESIGNATION
NUMBER

647 187 ROTARY ACTUATORS HELICAL HYDRAULIC L20 SERIE


70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 35

HYDRAULIC
70.1 HYDRAULIC SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
70.1.1 679449 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM

Brakes
3D - JIB
Turret rotation rotation
25 b mini
Compensation / Tilt
210 b
Steering
P 110b Arms 1/2 EV22
Basket T
150 b rotation Arm 3 Telescope Pendular arm EV23

210 b
220 b
12
19
120 b 20 110 b Only :
210 b 210 b
25 b 25 cm3 150 AETJC 3D
M1 A8 B8 B7 A6 B6 F PF T T1 A1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A4 B4 A5 B5 E
A7 B1 AETJ43 3D
180 b
EV2
According to 16 17
18
installation 2
80b
21 150 b 80 b A

70
EV18 EV1 EV16 EV6 EV8 EV10 EV12 EV14
14 EV7 EV11 EV13 EV15
EV19 EV5 EV17 EV9
EV2b M
3
160 b

M
2b
4 5 6 13 15 7 8 9 10 11

P
100 b
See Note 1
EV3
OIL TANK

150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D


AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D
150 AETJL
170 AETJL - AETJ 49
679449 Index E
547379EN
36 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 37

This diagram relates to lifting platforms :


- 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D
- AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D
- 150 AETJL ACTIVATION TABLE FOR THE ELECTRO-VALVES
- 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 ACCORDING TO THE DESIRED MOVEMENT
COMPONANTS OF THE HYDRAULIC LAYOUT
Please refer to the hydraulic layout to match the electro-valve numbers and their location on the platform
NOTE : Delivery of the block with the adjustment 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
AETJ standard E : Excited
ev3 ev2 ev2b ev18 ev19 ev1 ev5 ev16 ev17 ev6 ev7 ev8 ev9 ev10 ev11 ev12 ev13 ev14 ev15 ev22 ev23
21 Pressure restrictor 150 b
Stop
20 Hydro accumulator 75 ml 20 b
Transport Stop + steering E E or E
19 Pressure controller 25 b Position
translation E E E
18 Balancing valve 80 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
17 Balancing valve 180 b
Stop
16 Pressure reducer 80 b
Stop + steering E E or E
15 Valve 2b
translation E E E
14 Main pressure restrictor 160 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
13 Pressure reducer
Right E E
Turret Rotation
12 Rotating JIB (Option) Left E E

70
11 Compensation / Tilt Right E E
Basket Rotation
10 Pendular arm Left E E
9 Telescope Raising E E
Raising 1-2
8 Arm 3 Work Lowering E E
Position
7 Arms 1-2 Raising E E
Raising 3
6 Basket rotation Lowering E E
5 Steering Extended E E
Telescope
4 Turret rotation Retracted E E

3 Brakes Raising E E
Pendular arm
2 Brakes Lowering E E

1 Safety valve Boost E E


Tilt
AETJ Tilt E E

No. Function Standard Right E E


Jib Rotation (option)
Taring Left E E
547379EN
38 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 39

70.1.2 685268 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM

Brakes Compensation / Tilt


3D - JIB
Turret rotation
rotation

210 b
Steering E V 22

150 b Basket 25 b mini Arm 3 Telescope Pendular arm


Arms 1/2 E V 23
rotation
21

12 220 b

110 b
180 b 210 b 210 b 210 b
25 b
E 25 cm3
M1 A8 B8 B7 A6 B6 F PF T T1 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A4 B4 A5 B5
A7

180 b

18 19
E V2 20
2
80b
80 b A

EV 18 E V1 EV 16 E V6 E V8 E V 10 E V 12 E V 14
14 E V7

70
EV 19 E V5 E V 17 E V 2b E V9 E V 11 E V 13 E V 15

70
M

3
160 b

M
2b
4 5 6 13 15 7 8 9 10 11

P
100 b
1
See Note E V3

OIL TANK

120 AETJL
685268
Indice A
685268 Index A

Gamme AETJ - 547379


70-02-685268 FR (04/2008)
547379EN
40 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 41

This diagram relates to lifting platforms :


- 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D
- AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D
- 150 AETJL ACTIVATION TABLE FOR THE ELECTRO-VALVES
- 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 ACCORDING TO THE DESIRED MOVEMENT
COMPONANTS OF THE HYDRAULIC LAYOUT
Please refer to the hydraulic layout to match the electro-valve numbers and their location on the platform
NOTE : Delivery of the block with the adjustment 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
AETJ standard E : Excited
ev3 ev2 ev2b ev18 ev19 ev1 ev5 ev16 ev17 ev6 ev7 ev8 ev9 ev10 ev11 ev12 ev13 ev14 ev15 ev22 ev23

Stop
21 Pressure restrictor 25 b
Transport Stop + steering E E or E
20 Balancing valve 80 b Position
translation E E E
19 Balancing valve 180 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
18 Pressure restictor 80 b
Stop
16 Pressure restictor 150 b
Stop + steering E E or E
15 Shutter Valve 2b
translation E E E
14 Main pressure restrictor 160 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
13 Pressure reducer 150 b
Right E E
Turret Rotation
12 Rotating JIB (Option) Left E E

70
11 Compensation / Tilt Right E E
Basket Rotation
10 Pendular arm Left E E
9 Telescope Raising E E
Raising 1-2
8 Arm 3 Work Lowering E E
Position
7 Arms 1-2 Raising E E
Raising 3
6 Basket rotation Lowering E E
5 Steering Extended E E
Telescope
4 Turret rotation Retracted E E

3 Brakes Raising E E
Pendular arm
2 Brakes Lowering E E

1 Safety valve Boost E E


Tilt
AETJ Tilt E E

No. Function Standard Right E E


Jib Rotation (option)
Taring Left E E
547379EN
42 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 43

70.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS LOCATION

70.2.1 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE CHASSIS - LOCATION

Reducing gear/Brake
of left wheel

Steering cylinder

70
Reducing gear/Brake
of right wheel
547379EN
44 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.2.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE TURRET - LOCATION

Accumulator
150AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49

Oil tank

Electric pump

Backup pump
70

Turret rotation engine


Distributor block
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 45

70.2.3 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE JIB - LOCATION


- 120 AETJL :

Compensating cylinder

Telescope cylinder

Tilting cylinder

70
Arm 3 lifting cylinder
Jib cylinder

Arm 1-2 lifting arm


cylinder

Basket rotation
cylinder
547379EN
46 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

- 150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D, 150 AETJL, 170 AETJL, AETJ43, AETJ43 3D, AETJ 49 :

Compensating
cylinder
Telescope cylinder

Tilting cylinder

3D-JIB rotation
cylinder

Arm 3 lifting cylinder

Jib cylinder
Arm 1-2 lifting
70

arm cylinder

Basket rotation cylinder


547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 47

70.3 HYDRAULIC CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT

CAUTION
In this chapter, unless specifically indicated, in order to view the setting pressure values and choose
the appropriate pressure gauge, refer to the hydraulic diagrams (670.1.1 679449 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM,
5 35))37+ (670.1.2 685268 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM, 5 39)41

70.3.1 MAIN CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

70 - 11
M Setting the main pressure relief valve (14, 070.1.1), (14,, 070.1.2)

1
- On the distributor, connect a pressure gauge to M (1, 070 - 11).

- Switch on the access platform.

- Control the lowering of arms 1/2 and maintain the control when
the cylinder reaches the stop.
2

- Check that the pressure gauge displays the pressure recommended


in the hydraulic diagram.

- As required, adjust the setting of the main relief valve (2, 070 - 11).

70.3.2 STEERING, BASKET/TURRET ROTATION CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

70
Setting the pressure relief valve (13, 070.1.1), (13, 070.1.2)
70 - 12
- On the distributor, connect a pressure gauge to M1 (1, 070 - 12).

- Switch on the access platform.

- Control the steering to one side and maintain the control when
the cylinder reaches the stop.

2 - Check that the pressure gauge displays the pressure recommended


in the hydraulic diagram.

M1 1
- As required, adjust the setting of the pressure reducer (2, 070 - 12)
547379EN
48 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.3 BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

CAUTION
Procedure to be performed by two people.

Use a pressure gauge with a capacity of 0 - 250 bar (0-3625.94 psi).

The pressure switch is adjusted only by TIGHTENING the adjustment screw.

70 - 13
PRESSURE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
(17, 070.1.1),(19, 070.1.2)
2
0
- Place a Tee connector on the bypass at outlet F (1, 070 - 13) and
connect the pressure gauge (2, 070 - 13)
F .
- Switch on the access platform.
1

- Control the travel and check that the displayed pressure follows
70 - 14 P(bar)
the curve (1, 070 - 14):

1 If the pressure switch (2, 070 - 15) trips BELOW the threshold (2,
070 - 14), then, with the platform stationary, adjust the threshold
70

100>>120 bar by TIGHTENING the adjustment screw (2, 070 - 15).

- If the pressure switch (1, 070 - 15) trips ABOVE the threshold (2,
070 - 14), unscrew the adjustment screw by a few turns (2, 070 - 15),
25 bar then adjust it by TIGHTENING.
t(s)
2 Signal pressostat - Repeat the travel test.

70 - 15 NOTE: For the electrical aspects (6, 5 48)

PF
1

D-HY-278
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 49

70.3.4 TELESCOPIC CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

70 - 16
PRESSURE REDUCER SETTING
(16, 070.1.1), (18, 070.1.2)
0 1

A3 - Decompress the telescopic line (distributor) (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR


- REMOVAL, 5 57)

2
- Place a Tee connector on the by-pass at outlet A3 (1, 070 - 16) and
connect the pressure gauge (2, 070 - 16).

- Switch on the access platform.

- Move the telescope extension and keep it moving under it reaches


its full extent.

70 - 17 - Check that the pressure gauge displays the pressure recommended


in the hydraulic diagram.

- As required, adjust the setting of the pressure reducer (1, 070 - 17).

70
547379EN
50 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.5 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING


70 - 18
DECOMPRESSION OF THE CIRCUIT
- Decompression of the compensation/
A5 0
2
tilting circuit (6COMPENSATION/TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL, 5 64)

- Switch off the power to the access platform.

VALVE A ADJUSTMENT
(17, 070.1.1), (19, 070.1.2)

- Place a Tee connector on the by-pass at outlet A5 (1, 070 - 18) and
connect the pressure gauge (2, 070 - 18).
70 - 19

- Switch on the access platform.

70 - 20
- Follow steps (1, 070 - 20), (2, 070 - 21) and (3, 070 - 22): the
verification of the setting of valve A (1 , 070 - 19) and its
70

adjustment are to be carried out during movement 3.

1
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

70 - 21 70 - 22

2
TO I T S F U L L 3
EXTENT
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 51

70 - 23

VALVE B ADJUSTMENT
2 (18,, 070.1.1), (19, 070.1.2)
B5 0

- Place a Tee connector on the by-pass at outlet B5 (1, 070 - 23) and
connect the pressure gauge (1, 070 - 23)).
1
- Switch on the access platform.

70 - 24

70 - 25
- Follow steps (1, 070 - 25) and (2, 070 - 26): the verification of
the setting of valve A (1, 070 - 24) and its adjustment are to be

70
carried out during movement 2.

1
TO I T S F U L L
EXTENT

70 - 26

2
547379EN
52 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.6 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PROBLEM SOLVING

70 - 27 - If the basket does not remain in position and drops under gravity
when the access platform is not in operation, perform the following
test procedure.
2 TEST PROCEDURE
1
- Decompression of the compensation/tilting circuit (6 70.3.11
2 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Switch off the power to the access platform.


1

- Take a drain pan and place it under the compensating cylinder.

70 - 28 - Identify the hoses connected to the compensating cylinder lower


chamber (1, 070 - 27) and remove them.
3
A5 0 - Take a straight coupler and connect the hoses from the lower
B5
chamber.
4
2
0
- Perform the same procedure for the hoses for the upper chamber
1
(2, 070 - 27).
2
1
- Remove the hoses (1, 070 - 28) connected at A5 and B5 from the
distributor block.

- Insert tee couplings between the distributor block and the hoses
70

(2, 070 - 28).


70 - 29
- Take a 0 - 200 bar (0-2900.75 psi) manometer (3, 070 - 28) and
1
connect it to the left-hand tee coupling: outlet A5.

- Take a 0 - 100 bar (0-1450.38 psi) manometer (4, 070 - 28) and
connect it to the right-hand tee coupling: outlet B5.

- Switch on the access platform.


1
- Tilt the basket and jib to their maximum extent (1, 070 - 29) several
times from the base control panel to pressurize the hydraulic circuit.

- Place the basket in the horizontal position.

- Switch off the power to the access platform.

- Note the pressure readings displayed by the two manometers.

- Check that the basket does not drop.

NOTE: This procedure may take a long time (several hours).


547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 53

ANALYSIS OF RESULTS

- THE BASKET REMAINS IN POSITION AND THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE


HAS NOT DROPPED: the cylinder or the seals of the compensating
cylinder are faulty.

- Remove the compensation cylinder


(670.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the cylinder and check the condition of the seals. Change
70 - 30 the seals if required (see parts catalog)

- Check the condition of the cylinder barrel. Replace the cylinder if


1 it has scratch marks or traces of rust or pollution (see parts catalog)
1
- THE BASKET REMAINS IN POSITION AND THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE
HAS DROPPED IN ONE OR BOTH HYDRAULIC LINE(S): there is a
problem with the seal or the settings of one or both valves of the
distributor block.

- Decompression of the compensation/tilting circuit (6 70.3.11


CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the valve(s) (1, 070 - 30)and check the appearance of the
seals. Change the valves if the seals are defective (see parts catalog)

70
- Refit the valves then check their adjustment.............
(670.3.5 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING, 5 50)

- THE BASKET DROPS, THE PRESSURE ON BOTH MANOMETERS


TENDS TO BALANCE (+/- 10 BAR (145.1 psi)) OR THE PRESSURE
REMAINS CONSTANT IN LINE A5 AND FALLS IN LINE B5.

- Decompression of the compensation/tilting circuit (6 70.3.11


CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the tilting cylinder (670.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the cylinder and check the condition of the seals. Change
the seals if required (see parts catalog)

- Check the condition of the cylinder barrel. Replace the cylinder if


it has scratch marks or traces of rust or pollution (see parts catalog)
547379EN
54 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.7 TURRET ROTATION MOTOR - REMOVAL

70 - 31 - Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the turret rotation line (distributor) (6 70.3.10


DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL, 5 57)

- Open the left-hand turret cover (1, 070 - 31).

70 - 32 - Remove and plug the two hoses (1, 070 - 32).

- Remove the motor attachments (2, 070 - 32).

- Remove the steering motor (3, 070 - 32)


1 1 33 36kg (80 lbs)
2

3
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 55

70.3.8 ELECTRIC PUMP - REMOVAL

70 - 33
- Open the left-hand turret cover (1, 070 - 33).

70 - 34 Following fitting (see figure, 070 - 34), (see figure, 070 - 35):

- Remove and plug the hose (1, 070 - 34), (1, 070 - 35).

- Remove and plug the connector (2, 070 - 34), (2, 070 - 35).

3 - Remove the attachments (3, 070 - 34), (3, 070 - 35) and remove the
2 4 electric pump (4, 070 - 34), (4, 070 - 35)
33 25 kg (55 lbs)
1

70
70 - 35

1
547379EN
56 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.9 REDUCING GEARS/WHEEL BRAKES - REMOVAL

70 - 36 - Raise the rear of the access platform and place blocks under the
2 frame (1, 070 - 36):

33 120 AETJL : 2680 kg (5908 lbs)


1 33 150 AETJC : 3770 kg (8311 lbs)
33 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D : 3375 kg (7440 lbs)
33 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 3842 kg (8470 lbs)
33 AETJ43 - AETJ43 3D : 3775 kg (8323 lbs)

4 - Raise arm 1/2 by 3m (118.11 in) (2, 070 - 36).


3
3
- Remove the fasteners from the rear wheels (3, 070 - 32) and remove
the wheels.
D-HY-263 33 53 kg (117 lbs)

70 - 37 - Remove the cover (4, 070 - 36).

- Mark and then remove the electric cables connected to the


motors (1, 070 - 37).

- Remove the fasteners from one of the motors (2, 070 - 37) and
3 remove this motor (B-3).
1
33 27 kg (60 lbs)
1

- Repeat the same procedure on the second engine.


70

D-HY-264

70 - 38 - Remove and plug the hoses (1, 070 - 38).

- Remove the fasteners from one of the reducing gears/brakes (2,


070 - 38) and remove this assembly (3, 070 - 38).
33 50 kg (110 lbs)
3 2
- Repeat the same procedure on the second engine.

1
REFIT
22 Wheel nut maximum tightening torque 220 N.m (1947.2 lb-in).

D-HY-265
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 57

70.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL

WARNING
The hoses connected to the compensation/tilting cylinders are under pressure EVEN WHEN STOPPED.
Before carrying out work to remove the distributor, these hoses must be decompressed by following the steps (I, 070 - 41), (II,
070 - 40) and (III, 070 - 42) because this line cannot be decompressed from the distributor.

39
70 - 41 4 70 - 40 70 - 42

3m
II (118 in) 1 cm (0.4 in)

III
3
1

TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

4
I 2

D-HY-273

70 - 43
- Open the right-hand turret cover.
4

- Remove the manual indexed control protections (1, 070 - 43).

- Decompress the hydraulic lines:

70
3
1

- Pull, push the 3 non-indexed controls (2, 070 - 43) and allow them
to return to their equilibrium position.

4 - Pull, push the 5 indexed controls (3, 070 - 43) and return them to
2 their center position.

- Replace the manual indexed control protections (1, 070 - 43).

D-HY-273
- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the distributor.

- Identify the wiring harnesses connected to the solenoids and


disconnect them.

- Remove the distributor fasteners (4 , 070 - 43) and remove the


distributor.
33 25 kg (55 lbs)

REFIT
- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit (6COMPENSATION/TILTING
CYLINDER REMOVAL, 5 64)
547379EN
58 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 59

DISTRIBUTOR - DETAILS

21

15

14
13 21

20 6
7
12 20 8
11 18
4 A - 3D-JIB power
According to 5
installation 10 Scoop supply
PF

Jib
10
3 lowering
4 M
Telescope
retracted P 20
Hydraulic Hydraulic A
Item Designation diagram diagram
Tightening torque 16 P - Electric pump
in N.m (lb-in)
679449 685268
pressure
1 Distributor - - - Arm 3 Lowered
2 Electrovalve Item 4 Item 4
Backup pump
3 Electrovalve Items 5 - 6 Items 5 - 6 39 - 51 Nm 2 Arm 1/2

70
B5
4 Electrovalve Item 3 Item 3 (345.18-451.39 lb-in) pressure
5 Electrovalve Item 2 Item 2
Lowering B4 16
B3 A5 E
6 Electrovalve
Items 7 -8 - Items 7 -8 -
44 - 56 Nm 3D-JIB Rotation
9 - 10 9 - 10 A4
(389.43-495.64 lb-in) Option B2
7 Electrovalve Item 12 Item 12 A3
B1
8 Electrovalve Item 1 Item 1
39 - 51 Nm
(345.18-451.39 lb-in)
1 LH Basket T1 A2 19 Tilting
9
Pressure reducer -
Item 13 Item 13 - rotation A1
100 bar (1450.38 psi)
10 Plug - - - B6
11
Relief valve - 150 bar
Item 21 Item 16 B7 16 Jib up
(2176.50 psi) F
A6
12
Relief valve - 160 bar LH steering M1
B8
(2321.60 psi)
Item 14 Item 14 A7
T
Relief valve - 80 bar 34 - 41 Nm A8
13
(1160.80 psi)
Item 16 Item 18
(300.93-362.88 lb-in) 18 Telescope extended
14
Counterbalance valve -
Item 17 Item 19
17 9
180 bar (2611.80 psi)
Overload valve: 80 bar
Left-hand turret Brake
15
(1160.80 psi)
Item 18 Item 20
rotation 16 Arm 3 - Lifting
25 Nm
16 Valve - -
(221.27 lb-in)
Check valve - Right-hand turret
17 2 bar Item 15 Item 15 - rotation Return to tank Arm 1/2 - Lifting
(29.02 psi)
18 Valve - - -
19 Electrovalve - -
Pressure switch - 25b
20 Nm RH steering RH Basket rotation
20 Item 19 Item 21 (177.01 lb-in)
(362.75 psi)
21 Protector - - -
547379EN
60 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL


STEERING CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 44 - Raise the front (1, 070 - 44) of the access platform and place blocks
under the frame:

33 - 120 AETJL : 2400 kg (5291 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC : 3000 kg (6614 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D : 2550 kg (5622 lbs)
3 33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 3100 kg (6834 lbs)
2 33 - AETJ 43 - AETJ43 3D : 3775 kg (8322 lbs)

- Remove the front cover (2, 070 - 44).


1

- Open the right-hand turret cover (3, 070 - 44).

- Decompress the steering line (distributor) (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR


- REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 45 - Remove and plug the hoses connected to the steering cylinder


(1, 070 - 45).
2

- Remove the pivot pins from the steering cylinder (2, 070 - 45) and
remove the cylinder.
2
70

REFIT
1

- Carry out the removal operations in reverse order, leaving the


access platform on supports.

- Drain the steering circuit:

- Control the steering until it reaches its mechanical stop on both


sides, simultaneously repeating the operation several times.

- Remove the supports from under the front axle and carry out
steering tests while stationary, and then when moving.
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 61

ARM 1/2 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 46 - Raise arm 1/2 so that the intermediate hinge (1, 070 - 46) is raised
1m (39.37 in).

- Switch off the power supply.


2

- Secure the intermediate hinge with a hoist and a sling (2, 070 - 46):

1 33 - 120 AETJL: 1100 kg (2425 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - AETJ43 - AETJ 43 3D : 1600 kg (3527 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 1700 kg (3748 lbs)

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the arm 1/2 lifting line (distributor) (6 70.3.10


DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 47 - Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 47).

2
- Remove the pivot pins from the cylinder, starting with the cylinder
head pin (2, 070 - 47) and remove the cylinder:
33 - 120 AETJL : 25 kg (55 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - AETJ43 -
AETJ 43 3D - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 70 kg (154 lbs)
1
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder

70
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)

REFIT

- Carry out the removal operations in reverse order, leaving the


intermediate hinge supported by a strap.

- Slowly lower the intermediate hinge until the arms find their
equilibrium position.

- Remove the strap.

- Lower arms 1/2 to the transport position.

- Raise arms 1/2 to their maximum extent and repeat these operations
several times.
547379EN
62 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

ARM 3 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 48 - Raise the arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 070 - 48) is raised by
1m (39.37 in).

- Switch off the power supply.


1

1
- Secure the basket and arm 3 with a hoist (2, 070 - 48) and a sling
(stabilize with a support):

33 - 120 AETJL : 580 kg (1279 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D:
650 kg (1433 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 : 900 kg (1984 lbs)

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the lifting line of arm 3 (distributor) (6 70.3.10


DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 49 - Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 49).

- Remove the pivot pins from the cylinder, starting with the cylinder
foot pivot pin (2, 070 - 49) and remove the cylinder:
1

33 - 120 AETJL : 30 kg (66 lbs)


70

2
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - AETJ43 -
AETJ 43 3D - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 50 kg (111 lbs)

NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder


(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)

REFIT

- Lower arm 3 to the transport position.

- Raise arm 3 to its maximum extent and repeat these operations


several times
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 63

TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 50 - Raise arm 3 to the horizontal position (1, 070 - 50).

- Move the telescope extension (2, 070 - 50) by 1 m (39.37 in).


1 2

3
- Remove the cylinder head pivot pin (3, 070 - 50).

- Retract the telescope.

- Switch off the power supply.

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the telescopic line (distributor) (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR


- REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 51 - Remove the telescope base cover (1, 070 - 51).

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (2, 070 - 51).

2
1
- Remove the cylinder foot pivot pin (3, 070 - 51) and remove the
3
2
telescope cylinder:
33 - 120 AETJL : 34 kg (75 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D : 39 kg (86 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL : 42 kg (93 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 : 55 kg (121 lbs)

70
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)
547379EN
64 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

COMPENSATION/TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL


WARNING
The hose connected to the compensation/tilting cylinders are pressurized EVEN WHEN STOPPED.
Before carrying out work to remove the cylinders, these hoses must be decompressed by following
the steps (I, 070 - 53), (II, 070 - 52) and (III, 070 - 54) because this line cannot be decompressed from the
distributor.

70 - 53 70 - 52 70 - 54

3m
(118.11in)
II 1 cm (0.39 in)

III

TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

70 - 55

Compensating cylinder

1 - Raise arm 1/2 so that the intermediate hinge (1, 070 - 55) is raised
1m (39.37 in).
70

- Switch off the power supply.

- Secure the basket/jib assembly with a hoist and a sling:


33 without rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 with rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 267 kg (589 lbs)

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Remove the cylinder pivot pins (1, 070 - 56) and remove the cylinder
70 - 56
from the arms while leaving it connected to the hoses:
33 - 120 AETJL : 18 kg (40 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL : 20 kg (44 lbs)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder and remove
1
the cylinder.
NOTE: This cylinder has no valves.

REFIT

- Follow the removal operations in reverse order.


- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit by repeating steps I to
VII several times (I & II, 070 - 59), (III & IV, 070 - 62), (V & VI, 070 - 61),
(VII, 070 - 60).
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 65

70 - 57
2
Tilting cylinder

- Move the telescope extension by 1m (1, 070 - 57).


- Switch off the power supply.
1 - Secure the basket/jib assembly with a hoist and a sling (2, 070 - 57):
1 m (39.37 in) 33 without rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 with rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 267 kg (589 lbs)
- Place the assembly on a stable surface.

- Remove the cylinder pivot pins (2, 070 - 58) and remove the cylinder
from the arms while leaving it connected to the hoses.
70 - 58
33 - 22 kg (49 lbs)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 58)
2 2 and remove the cylinder.

1
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)

REFIT
- Follow the removal operations in reverse order.
- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit by repeating steps I to
VII several times (I & II, 070 - 59), (III & IV, 070 - 62), (V & VI, 070 - 61),
(VII, 070 - 60).
.
70 - 59 70 - 62 TO ITS FULL
TO ITS FULL EXTENT

70
EXTENT

IV

II III
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

70 - 61 70 - 60

TO ITS FULL
EXTENT
VII

V
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

VI
547379EN
66 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

JIB CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 63 - Lift the jib (1, 070 - 63) to the horizontal position.


2
- Switch off the power supply.

- Secure the basket with a hoist and a sling (2, 070 - 63)
33 - 170 kg (375 lbs)

- Place the assembly on a stable surface.


1

70 - 64 - Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the jib lifting line (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL,


5 57)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 64).
2
1
- Remove the pivot pins from the cylinder, starting with the cylinder
foot pivot pin (2, 070 - 64) and remove the cylinder:
33 - 15 kg (33 lbs)
70

NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder


(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 67

BASKET ROTATION CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 65 - Lift the jib (1, 070 - 65) to the horizontal position.

- Switch off the power supply.

- Open the right-hand turret cover.


70 - 66

- Decompress the basket rotation line (6 70.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR -


REMOVAL, 5 57)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 49).
1
3
2 - Remove the cylinder foot pivot pin (2, 070 - 66) and the nut of the
cylinder head pin (3, 070 - 66) and remove the cylinder.

70
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)
547379EN
68 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

ROTATION CYLINDER (3D - JIB) - REMOVAL

70 - 67 - Decompression of the tilting cylinder circuit (6COMPENSATION/


TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL, 5 64).

- Move the telescope extension by 1 m (39.37 in)

- Switch off the power supply.

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

1 m (39.37 in) - Decompress:


⇒⇒ the jib lifting line
⇒⇒ the 3D rotation cylinder line.

- Secure the basket/jib assembly with a hoist and a sling (see


figure, 070 - 67).
33 - 267 kg (589 lbs).

70 - 68 - Remove and plug the hoses from the 3D rotation cylinder (2, 070 - 68).

- Remove the basket/jib assembly (1, 070 - 67), if necessary remove


the harnesses and the hoses of the jib cylinder (6JIB CYLINDER -
4
REMOVAL, 5 66).

2
- Remove the 3D rotation cylinder pivot pin (1, 070 - 68).
70

- Secure the 3D rotation cylinder assembly with a hoist and a sling


70 - 69 (see figure, 070 - 69).
33 - 37 kg (82 lbs)

- Démonter l’axe d’articulation du vérin d’inclinaison (3, 070 - 68),


et l’axe d’articulation du bras (4, 070 - 68).

Remove the 3D rotation cylinder.

REFIT
- Follow the removal operations in reverse order.

- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit by repeating steps I to


VII several times (I & II, 070 - 59), (III & IV, 070 - 62), (V & VI, 070 - 61),
(VII, 070 - 60).

- Purge the 3D rotation cylinder, if it rebounds excessively after


being connected. Perform at least 5 rotations to its maximum extent.
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 69

VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL

WARNING
A cylinder fitted with valves may have chambers with VERY HIGH PRESSURES, higher than 100 bars (1450.38 psi) (tilting cylinder
or cylinder with rod fully retracted or extended) even after being removed. The pressures in the chambers should be released
before disassembly.

CAUTION
Ideally, this procedure should only be carried out on cylinders whose ROD is at MID-STROKE.
In order to work under optimum safety conditions, the operator must wear protective goggles, rubber gloves, and carry a rubber
sheet

Removal of a fitted valve block

WARNING
In order to avoid pressurized oil leaks, the operator should position the cylinder with the contact face (1, 070 - 70) between the
valve block and the cylinder, vertically, and then position a rubber sheet over this face (2, 070 - 70).

70 - 70 - Secure the cylinder body in a vise.


HAUT
- Loosen the fixing screws of the block (3, 070 - 70) one after another,
by a MAXIMUM of 1/4 turn for each screw.
2

1 BAS - Unscrew the screws by 1/4 turn WITH A SPANNER until the
pressure has been released.

70
3 3

Removal of a valve
3
3
- Secure the cylinder body in a vice

WARNING
In order to avoid pressurized oil leaks, the operator should position a rubber sheet (1, 070 - 71) over the valve seat after positioning
its wrench

70 - 71 Loosen the valves (2, 070 - 71) in turn: MAXIMUM 1/4 of a turn per
valve.

1 - Unscrew the valves by 1/4 turn WITH A SPANNER until the


pressure has been released.

2
547379EN
70 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
ELECTRICITY

TABLE OF CONTENTS

80.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73

80.1.1 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75

80.1.2 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASE CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76

80.1.3 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

80.1.4 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78

80.1.5 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79

80.1.6 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80

80.1.7 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81


80.1.8 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82

80.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

80.2.1 ELECTRICAL CONTROL COMPONENTS - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

80.2.2 ELECTRICAL POWER COMPONENTS - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84

80.4.4 WIRING BASED ON SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM 676423 - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85

LOCATION OF WIRING HARNESSES ON THE ACCESS PLATFORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85

BASKET CONTROL PANEL HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86

OVERLOAD SENSORS HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89

UPPER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90

LOWER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92

UPPER BUS-CAN CONTROL PANEL OUTPUT HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93

BASE BOX HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94

80
VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96

ELECTROVALVE HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99

80.3 ELECTRICAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101

80.3.1 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102

EXTERNAL VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102

INTERNAL VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105


547379EN
72 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.3.2 IES BATTERY CHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106

IES BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106

IES BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

EXTERNAL VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

IES BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

80.3.3 ELECTRONIC MODULES - CONTROL AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS DESCRIPTION AND WIRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110

ELECTRONIC MODULES - DIAGNOSTICS AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

80.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - WIRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DIAGNOSTIC AND ADJUSTMENT TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118

BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR/HOUR METER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120

80.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

SWITCHES - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

TILT SENSOR - SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

ARM DOWN SENSORS - SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127

BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - CHECKING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128

OVERLOAD SENSORS - SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129

MULTIMETER TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132

80.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133

MANIPULATOR - TESTS USING CALIBRATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133


80

MANIPULATOR - TEST WITH A VOLTMETER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134

80.4 ELECTRICITY REMOVALS - REFITTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136

80.4.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136

80.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

80.4.3 ELECTRICAL HARNESSES - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138

80.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139

80.5.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - FAULTS AND FIXES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139

80.5.2 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - ERROR SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143

80.5.3 IES BATTERY CHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143

80.6 SPECIFIC TOOLING - ELECTRICITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

80.6.1 CALIBRATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 73

ELECTRICITY

80.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS

WARNING
Diagram 1 VERSIONst

Access platform fitted with an overload sensor harness comprising:


a Deutsch connector with........................................................... 8-way

SQ5a SQ5a

SQ5b

WARNING
Diagram 2 VERSIONnd

Access platform fitted with an overload sensor harness comprising:


a Deutsch connector with........................................................... 3-way

80
SQ5a

SQ5b SQ5b
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 75

80.1.1 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators hyave a nominal voltage of 24 V *

B
CHARGER
(network)

yellow
white

black singles Base control


blue Platform control
green Emergency
stop
Nr. 2 BASKET
C /BASE
RED GREEN
selector

black TILT/SLOPE
red

D
ELECTRIC-PUMP 678423 - Index R
Page 1/4
325

arm low A

VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (power) VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (logic) supply


E pressure stat
tel. retracted A

Base select.
tilt
line
trac./pump

Left Right
TRACTION MOTORS

telescope
arm low

80
retracted

te tra a)
pressure stat. pump

to
TRACTION/

le ct

ar
LINE

re (
sc ed

m
el
(brakes

op
PUMP

ec 48V
CONTACTOR

lo
tro

w
e
BATTERY POWER Emergency SWITCHING released)

(a
-v

)
CHARGE

alv
ON stop 2

s e
H

J
547379EN
76 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.2 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASE CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators have a nominal voltage of 24V *

C
CAN bus socket : Diagnostics
Connection to the calibrator
MOLEX Mini-Fit box 678423 - Index R
for male / 6 way contacts
Page 2/4
Pendular arm

rotation
arm
Pendular

JIB rotation Right


Turret
rotation

JIB rotation Left


pendular arm/Down Send to tank
pendular arm/Up Klaxon
telescope/Retracted Flashing light
telescope/Extended
D turret rot. Right
JIB rot. L
JIB rot. R
turret rot. Left Turret rot. Left
Basket rot. Left
compensation R
pendular arm R
telescope Extended
arm 3 R
arms 1,2 R
Tilt
Basket
rotation

Arms
Arm

compensation / Down turret rot. R


compensation / Up steering R
arm 3 / Down basket rot. R
arm 3 / Up compensation Up
arm 1/2 / Down
E arm 1/2 / Up brake
basket rot. Right steer L
basket rot. Left pump
pendular arm Up
telescope extended
arm 3 Up
arms 1.2 Up
CONTROL CONSOLE

Timer
80

white/brown
white/blue
blue
G brown

ARMS ARM PENDULAR ARM TILT BASKET PENDULAR ARM S


M St Br Br St TURRET Se upp Fla
O ee ak ak ee Ho
wa ver wa ain rL e e rR S nd ly shi rn
rn loa rn ten ef
t ig ele upp Do Do Ex Re Up
Do to ng
in d in an ht ct ly t Up Up wn te tra wn Do Ri Le Ri Le tan lig
g g c ro o wn n ct Up wn gh f gh ht
e -v sio io t f t Ri Le k
alv t t gh f
H es
n n
t
t

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 77

80.1.3 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators have a nominal voltage of 24V *

C Overload arms 1/2 arm 3 - Basket pendular arm


- Turret
horn

678423 - Index R
Page 3/4
Emergency stop
horn
D pendular arm selection
power telescope selection
supply compensation selection
power JIB rotation
supply turret rotation
basket rotation
Arm 3 selection
Arms 1/2 selection
translation selection
SQ5a Overload Overload warning
SQ5b Overload overload
maintenance warning Maintenance warning
Overload buzzer
E pendular arm
telescope
compensation
JIB rotation
turret rotation
basket rotation
instruction rotation arm 3
steer left arms 1/2
steer right translation
traction instruction tilt
Dead man’s system alarm/faults
Except for NEUTRAL Ref. Overload
Ref. tilt
F

green
yellow
blue
black

80
grey (Y)
violet
red
pink
G brown
white

Overload Tilt ARMS ARM BASKET TURRET PENDULAR


24V 2-AXIS joystick warning ROTATION ARM
H (red)
(All the LEDs are supplied with 24V)

J
547379EN
78 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.4 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators have a nominal voltage of 24V *
B

Sector sensor control module

D 678423 - Index R
Page 4/4
arm low B
arm low A
telescope retracted A
telescope retracted B
overload SQ5a
E overload SQ5b
speed reduction return
overload validation return

speed return
overload validation

F
(+ dedicated soft)
80

H
ar w

re
lo
m

tra
tec

I
d

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 79

80.1.5 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

CHARGER
C
(network)

yellow supply
white

black (singles LEDS) B: Base control 678423 - Index S


blue
green
Base
P: Platform control Page 1/4
Emergency
Stop
BASE/
RED GREEN BASKET
Selector

D
black SLOPE
red

ELECTRIC- PUMP
3,6 KW/48V

+10V5 : A1
E 0V : A2
n. c. : A3
+10V5 : A4
CAN-H : A5
CAN-L : A6
VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (logic)

arm low A : B3
supply : B1
VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (power) pressure stat : B2
tel_retracted_A : B06
Base selector : B5
slope : B4
: B7
F line : B8
trac./pump : B9
+12v : B12

80
Left Right
TRACTION MOTORS
G SEM XP1747,48V
retracted arm low

Eleupp
s

ar
ct ly

m
ro
LINE pump

-v

lo
TRACTION/PUMP pressure stat

alv

w
CONTACTOR (brakes released)
SWITCHING

es
BATTERY EMERGENCY

re
POWER ON

t
CHARGE STOP 2

ra
ct
ed
H

J
547379EN
80 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.6 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

CAN-L : CAN-6 CAN bus socket : Diagnostics


CAN-H : CAN-5
+12V : CAN-4 MOLEX Mini-Fit box B: Base control
P: Platform control
678423 - Index S
0V : CAN-2 for males/ 6 way contacts
Page 2/4
arm rot.
Pendular

+12V : CAN-1
arm
Pendular
rotation
Turret

B+
Di 01 : JIB rot. R B+2
Di 16 : JIB rot. L
Di 13 : pendular arm/Down send to tank : Do 01
Di 12 : pendular arm/Up horn : Do 19
flashing light : Do 20
D Di 08 : telescope/Retracted
Di 09 : telescope/Extended rot. JIB L : Do 11
Di 07 : Right turret rot. rot. JIB R : Do 17
Di 06 : Left turret rot. turret rot. L : Do 08
basket rot. : Do 12
compensation R : Do 14
pendular arm R : Do 06
telescope R : Do 09
arm 3 R : Do 04
arms 1,2 R : Do 02
arm
Lower

arm
Upper
rotation
Basket

Tilt

Di 11 : compensation/down turret rot. R : Do 10


Di 10 : compensation/down Steer R : Do 16
Di 05 : upper arm 3 /Down basket rot. R : Do 18
Di 04 : upper arm 3 /Up compensation Up : Do 21
Di 03 : lower arm 1,2 /Down
E Di 02 : lower arm 1,2 /Up brake : Do 22
Di 15 : Right basket rot. steer L : Do 15
Di 14 : Left basket rot. pump : Do 24
pendular arm Up : Do 07
telescope Extended : Do 13
arm 3 Up : Do 05
arms 1,2 Up : Do 03
C-NEG
D-NEG
B-NEG

Timer
80

TILT
Br

ARMS ARM PENDULAR ARM BASKET PENDULAR ARM


Br

TURRET
St

Fla
ak

Ho
St
Ov ar

M w

ak

ROTATION ROTATION

Se
El
Su ctro
ee

ROTATION
ee
e
ain ar

sh
e
e

rn
w
er nin

nd
rL

pp -v

(JIB)
rR

Su o ta

i
lo g

ng
te nin

Re

Do
ef

Do
ly alv

Do

Ex

t
Le
ad

pp nk
ig

Do
Up

Up
na g

Up

Ri
t

tra

Le
Up

Ri

lig
to es

te

w
w
ht

f
gh

ly
nc

t
w

Le
gh

f
n
n

ct

ht
n

Ri
t
n
sio

t
e

f
io

gh

t
n
n

t
H

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 81

80.1.7 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

C
1 - basket
Overload arms 1.2 arm 3 2 - turret compensation pendular arm
selection selection 3 - JIB selection selection horn
678423 - Index S
Page 3/4
CAN6 : CAN-L
Basket CAN5 : CAN-H
Emergency stop
D Di 16 : horn
Di 12 : pendular arm selection
Di 11 : telescope selection
Di 13 : compensation selection
Di 08 : JIB rot.
Di 15 : turret rot. B+
Di 14 : basket rot. B+2
Di 10 : arm 3 selection B/NEG
Di 09 : arms 1,2 selection C/NEG
Di 03 : translation selection D/NEG
Di 05 : SQ5b overload
overload : Do 21 Overload warning
Di 02 : (available) Maintenance warning
maintenance warning : Do 19
Overload buzzer : Do 15
E pendular arm : Do 05
telescope : Do 04
compensation : Do 07
JIB rot. : Do 06
turret rot. : Do 01
basket rot. : Do 08
Ai 01 : rotation instruction arm 3 : Do 03
Di 06 : steer Left arms 1,2 : Do 02
Di 07 : steer Right translation : Do 13
Ai 02 : traction instruction slope : Do 16
Di 01 : Dead man's system alarme/faults : Do 14
Di 04 : Except for NEUTRAL Ref. overload : Do 18
(spare) : Do 22

green
yellow
yellow/black
grey/black
grey (Y)
green/black

80
brown/black
white/black
brown
white
G

Overload Slope ARMS 1.2 ARM 3 BASKET TURRET JIB PENDULAR ARM
24V 2-AXIS JOYSTICK warning (red) ROTATION ROTATION ROTATION

(all the LEDs are supplied with 24V)

J
547379EN
82 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.8 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

Sector sensor control module


678423 - Index S
C
Page 4/4

A5 : CAN-L
A6 : CAN-H

D
B02 : arm low B
B01 : arm low A
B03 : telescope retracted A
B04 : telescope retracted B
B05: overload SQ5b
B06 : overload SQ5a
B07 : speed reduction return
BO8 : overload validation return
E

Out_2 :
Out_1 : Overload Validation

( + dedicated soft)

F
80

H
lo te
w lesc
ar op
m
(b er
) et
ra
c te
d

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 83

80.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS LOCATION

80.2.1 ELECTRICAL CONTROL COMPONENTS - LOCATION


Rotating
Retracted telescope beacon light Tilt sensor
sensor

Horn Base control panel

Safety control card


Arm down sensors
150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49

Base module control unit

Basket module control unit

80
Basket control panel

LED showing charging states Battery charge indicator/


Low arm sensors 120 AETJL
removed hour meter

Overload sensors
547379EN
84 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.2.2 ELECTRICAL POWER COMPONENTS - LOCATION

Electric pump

Left-hand battery

Variable speed controller Safety control card


plate

Left traction motor Right-hand battery


80

Battery cut-off

Variable speed controller


plate relay

IES charger
Right traction motor
ZIVAN charger
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 85

80.4.4 WIRING BASED ON SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM 676423 - 1ST VERSION

LOCATION OF WIRING HARNESSES ON THE ACCESS PLATFORM 13

13 3 12
3 4 5 2

1 2
10

15
9
15

11 8
12
14

16

120 AETJL

Item Designation
1 Basket control panel
2 Upper CAN extension harness
3 Lower CAN extension harness
4 BUS-CAN harness output
5 Base box
6 Variable speed controller harness
7 Electrovalve harness
8 Tilt wiring harness
9 Horn harness
10 Flashing flight harness
11 Output sensor control panel harness
12 - Intermediate inductive sensors harness
(150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49)
- Telescopic arm sensors harness (120 AETJL)
13 Telescope arm sensor
14 Low arm sensor harness

80
15 Arm down sensor
13
16 Overload sensors
15 15 3 4 14 5 2 13 3 12

10

1 2

11 8
12

16
6
7

150 AETJL
150 AETJLC
150 AETJC 3D
150 AETJL
170 AETJL
AETJ 43
AETJ 43 3D
547379EN
86 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

BASKET CONTROL PANEL HARNESS


- ITEM 1
Installation procedure:
- 678383 - C (120 AETJL, 150 AETJC,150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL,170 AETJL).

S13 S15 S19 S20 S18 S22

H18 137 135


H7
1 1
311
305
H10 H15
330 331
303 2 2
A5 H16 H14
327 304
309
322
321 323 106 106 123 123
106
H9
328 307
308 S17
S21
302
H8
103
310
S14 306
329 103
103

106

HD 30

8S 320
1 2
8 7

8P PC
3 4
6 5

8P H17
314

CIRC IMP

313 103

To overload To overload
BASKET CONSOLE sensors harness sensors harness
HARNESS Ref. 16 Ref. 16
Ref. 1
80

HD 30a

8S 8P 8P PC 15
16 14
17 5 4 13
Ref. Designation Ref. Designation
18 1
1 2 3 4 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 6 3
12
8 7 6 5 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8 19 11 A4 Basket module card S13 Translation selector
20
7 2 10 A5 Manipulator S14 Arm 1/2 up / down selector
8 9 PRINT.CIRC Printed circuit S15 Arm 3 up / down selector
H7 Tilt LED S17 Pendular arm / turret / basket rotation selector
Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire H8 Translation LED S18 Tilt / reverse tilt selector
1 green 1 314 1 332 1 112 H9 Arm 1/2 up LED S19 Telescope extension / retraction selector
2 yellow 2 315 2 335 2 113
3 yellow/black H10 Arm 3 up LED S20 Pendular arm up / down selector
3 316 3 312 3 spare
4 grey/black 4 317 4 335 4 135 H14 Tilt / reverse tilt LED S21 Horn button
5 white 5 123 5 333 5 137 H15 Telescope LED
6 white/black S22 Emergency Stop
6 103 6 335 6 spare H16 Pendular arm up LED
brown/black 7 319 7 spare 7 332 8S 8-port male Deutsch connector
brown 8 318 8 spare 8 333 H17 Buzzer
7 green/black 8P 8-port female Deutsch connector
9 338 H18 Overload LED 8P PC 8-port female Deutsch through-partition connector
8 grey 10 103
11 106 HD30 20-port female Deutsch through-partition connector
12 123
13 336
14 337
15 319
16 400 Optional spare
17 401 Optional spare
18 402 Optional spare
19 spare
20 spare
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 87

- ITEM 1
Installation procedure:
- 52501871. (150 AETJC,150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL,170 AETJL)
- 52556918. (AETJ 43,AETJ 43 3D, AETJ 49)

S14 S15 S19 S20 S18 S22

H18 137 135


H7 103
1 1
310
305
H10 H15
330 331
2 2
A5 H16 303 H14
327 304
309
322
321 323 106 123 4S
106
H9 106 12P7 123 4S

328 307
308 S17
S21
302
H8
103
311
S13 306
329 103
103

103 8P 6

106

12P PC
4P PC

320
12 11 10 9
1 2 3 4
1 2
8 7

4
1

8P PC
3 4
6 5

3
2

5 6
8 7

H17
314
6S
4S
CIRC IMP

313 103

To overload To upper BUS CAN


BASKET sensors harness extension harness

80
CONSOLE HARNESS
Ref. 16 Rep. 2
Ref. 1

Ref. Designation Ref. Designation


6S 4S 8P PC 4P 12P A4 Basket module card S13 Translation selector
A5 Manipulator S14 Arm 1/2 up / down selector
4 3
PRINT.CIRC Printed circuit S15 Arm 3 up / down selector
4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7
5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 H7 Tilt LED S17 Pendular arm / turret / basket rotation selector
1 2
H8 Translation LED S18 Tilt / reverse tilt selector
H9 Arm 1/2 up LED S19 Telescope extension / retraction selector
Pos Wire Pos Wire Pos Wire Pos Wire Pos Wire
1 318 1 123 1 332 1 338 1 112 H10 Arm 3 up LED S20 Pendular arm up / down selector
2 315 2 103 2 335 2 400 2 113 H14 Tilt / reverse tilt LED S21 Horn button
3 316 3 103 3 312 3 401 3 135 H15 Telescope LED S22 Emergency Stop
4 317 4 103 4 335 4 402 4 137 H16 Pendular arm up LED
5 314 5 333 4S 4-port male Deutsch connector
5 333
6 319 6 335 H17 Buzzer 6S 6-port male Deutsch connector
6 103
7 libre 7 106 H18 Overload LED 8P PC 8-port female Deutsch through-partition connector
8 libre 8 123 4P PC 4-port female
9 336 Deutsch through-partition connector
10 337 12P PC 12-port female
11 319 Deutsch through-partition connector
12 332
547379EN
88 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Basket module control unit

D-IN D-OUT D-NEG A-IN CAN


C-NEG
A4 B+2 B+ B-NEG

106 103

103 103

103 according to installation

16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 8 7 6 5 6 5 4
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


Pos. Wire
1 spare 1 315 1 spare
1 319
2 328 2 318 2 spare
2 312
3 327 3 spare 3 spare
3 311
4 322 4 spare 4 spare
4 313
5 321 5 spare 5 113
5 332
6 spare 6 spare 6 112
6 316
7 323 7 spare
7 317
8 spare 8 spare
80

8 306
9 spare
9 310
10 spare
10 309
11 spare
11 304
12 spare
12 303
13 305 13 329
14 308 14 331
15 307 15 320
16 302 16 330
17 spare
18 335
19 337
20 spare
21 336
22 338
23 spare
24 spare
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 89

OVERLOAD SENSORS HARNESS


- ITEM 16

To full basket control


panel
Item 1

5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1

Pin Wire Color


1 332 black
2 335 black/white
3 312 brown
OVERLOAD SENSORS
4 335 blue
HARNESS 5 333 black

80
678849 - D 6 335 black/white
Item 16 7 - free
8 - free

SQ5a SQ5b
547379EN
90 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

UPPER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS


- ITEM 2
Installation procedure:
678855 - C (120 AETJL)
678387 - D (150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL)
678643 - E (170 AETJL)

15
14 16
To complete 17
basket console 13 4 5
12 1 18
Ref. 1 3 6
11 19
2 7 20
10
9 8

Pos. Wire
1 112
2 113
3 Spare
4 135
5 137
6 Spare
7 332
8 333
9 338
10 103
11 106
12 123
13 336
14 337
15 319
16 400 optional spare
17 401 optional spare
18 402 optional spare
19 Spare

UPPER BUS CAN 20 Spare

EXTENSION HARNESS
Ref. 2
80

1
8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 112
2 113
3 135
4
5
137
332
2
6 333
7 402 8 7 6 5
8 338 1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 103
2 106
3 123
4 336
5 337
6 319
7 400
8 401
To lower CAN BUS
extension bundle
Ref. 3
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 91

Installation procedure:
52501939.(150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL, AETJ 43, AETJ 43 3D)
52501918. (170 AETJL, AETJ 49)

To complete
basket console
Ref. 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 338 1 112
2 400 2 113
3 401 3 135
4 402 4 137
5 333
6 103
7 106
8 123
9 336
10 337
11 319
12 332

UPPER BUS CAN


EXTENSION HARNESS
52501939 (150 AETJC - 150 AETC 3D - 150 AETJL - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D)
52501918. (170 AETJL - AETJ 49)
Ref. 2

1 80
8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 112
2 113
3 135
4
5
6
137
332
333
2
7 402
8 338 8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 103
2 106
3 123
4 336
5 337
6 319
To lower BUS CAN 7 400
extension harness 8 401
Ref. 3
547379EN
92 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

LOWER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS


- ITEM 3 To upper BUS CAN
extension harness
as mounting
Ref. 2

5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1

1
Pos. Wire Pos. Wire
1 112 1 103
2 113 2 106
3 135 3 123
4 137 4 336
5 332 5 337

2
6 333 6 319
7 402 7 400
8 338 8 401

LOWER BUS CAN


EXTENSION BUNDLE
678863 - B (120 AETJL)
678388 - D (150 AETJ COMPACT - 150 AETJC 3D
150 AETJL - 170 AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49)
Ref. 3
80

1 2
8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 112 1 103
2 113 2 106
3 135 3 123
4 137 4 336
5 332 5 337
6 333 6 319
7 402 7 400
8 338 8 401

To BUS CAN console


output bundle
Ref. 4
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 93

UPPER BUS-CAN CONTROL PANEL OUTPUT HARNESS


- ITEM 4 To lower BUS CAN
extension harness
Ref. 3

5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1 5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 112 1 103
2 113 2 106
3 135 3 123
4
5
6
137
332
333
1 2 4
5
6
336
337
319
7 402 7 400
8 338 8 401

BUS CAN CONSOLE


OUTPUT HARNESS
678394 - C
Ref. 4

80
402 401 400 319 338 333 332 137 135 113 123 112 103 106 337 336

To complete base box


Rep. 5
547379EN
94 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

BASE BOX HARNESS


- ITEM 5 A3 A6

241 407 106


103 103

107 242
242 408

KA1
KA10
KA11

319 106
263 405 406
106 106

OUTPUT

338 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 112 112 113 243 TERMINAL
119 109 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 106 112 113 113 243

INPUT

338 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 112 112 113 243
119 109 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 106 112 113 113 243

104
137

BUS CAN console ensor console


output harness output harness
F3 + 24V F2 + 24V Ref. 4 Ref. 11

Variable speed Flashing light


drive harness Electro-valve Tilt Alarm harness
Ref. 6 harness
100 101 harness harness Ref. 10
Ref. 7
Ref. 8 Ref. 9

D-IN D-OUT D-NEG A-IN CAN


C-NEG
A3 B+2 B+ B-NEG
80

106 103

4 5 6
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 6 5 4
1 2 3
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 215 1 262 1 jaune J1-1 1 jaune J1-1
2 214 2 227 2 jaune J1-2 2 jaune J1-2
3 213 3 239 3 127 3 127
4 212 4 226 4 243 4 243
5 211 5 238 5 113 5 113
6 208 6 224 6 112 6 112
7 207 7 236
8 205 8 221
9 206 9 225
10 201 10 228
11 202 11 219
12 209 12 222
13 210 13 237
14 204 14 223 BASE BOX
15 203 15 234 HARNESS
16 216 16 229
17 220 679459 - G (120 AETJL
18 230 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL
19 217 52556928. (AET 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49)
20 218
21 231 Ref. 5
22 233
23 spare
24 235
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 95

216 263 204 263


263 215 263 203

S8
206 263
S11 263 205
S7
S9

211 S6 210
263 263 115 337
263 263 114 336
yellow yellow
212
209
116 106 yellow
S10 263
H1 H2 H3 H4
6 5 4 263
3 2 1
213 108 108
263 S23
110
263
108 105
214
P2
1 1
S5 202
S2
3 3 3 3 3 S3 2 2
4 4 4 4 4
263
208 263
201
263 207

S12
103 135 104 137 F3
106 123
137 CAN BUS

B+ OUT2 B
A6 B- OUT1 CAN SECU

6 5 4
3 2 1

106 405
Pos. Wire
spare 103 406
1
2 103
3 243
4 243

80
5 113
6 112
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 6 5 4
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 117 1 spare
2 244 2 spare
3 118 3 spare
4 245 4 spare
5 332 5 113
6 333 6 112
7 407
Pos. Designation Pos. Designation 8 408
9 spare
A3 Base module card S2 Emergency Stop
10 spare
A6 Security control card S3 Base/basket selector 11 spare
F2 15A fuse S5 Turret rotation selector 12 spare
F3 5A fuse S6 Telescope extension / retraction selector 13 spare
H1 Offset LED indicator - red LED S7 Pendular arm up / down selector 14 spare
15 spare
H2 Offset LED indicator - green LED S8 Pendular arm rotation selector
16 spare
H3 Overload warning LED S9 Basket rotation selector 17 spare
H4 Maintenance warning LED S10 Arm 3 up / down selector 18 spare
KA1 Electro-valve supply relays S11 Arm 1/2 up / down selector 19 spare
KA10 Relay S12 Tilt / reverse tilt selector 20 spare
KA11 Relay S23 Dead man’s button 21 spare
22 spare
P2 Timer
23 spare
24 spare
547379EN
96 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER HARNESS


- ITEM 6

103

A
6 5 4
3 2 1

To
VARIABLE SPEED
Pos. Wire
variable speed drive
1 spare HARNESS
drive board
2 spare 678397 - C
3 127
4 spare Ref. 6
5 113
6 112

B- B
B+ F1 12 11 10 9 8 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
F2
114
R A Pos. Wire
1 106
S 2 119 115
3 117
4 109
5 108 116
6 118
7 107
105
8 102
9 130
10 spare 110
11 121
12 spare
103

113

110
To charger 101

105
4 2 5 112
1 3
100
Pos. Wire Colour
1 115 brown 127
2 Spare
3 116 white
4 Spare 107
5 Spare
Shield. 114 Green
235

117

108
80

To 109
variable speed drive
F1 KM1 fuses board
118
101
KM3 KM2
119
102

106 106

130
106
106
103
121

106
To complete
235 base box
Ref. 5
According to
installation
To right-hand
battery + terminal

132

To battery cut-out
132

100
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 97

ELECTROVALVE HARNESS
ELECTRO-VALVE HARNESS
- ITEM 7 678393 - E
Ref. 4
Pos. Wire Couleur Liaison
2
EV6 - LOWER ARM UP
1 241 Bown
1
2 239 White D OUT 03

2
EV8 - UPPER ARM UP 1 241 Bown
1
2 238 White D OUT 05

2
EV10 - TELESC. EXTENTED 1 241 Bown
1
2 237 White D OUT 13

2
EV12 - PENDULAR ARM UP
1 241 Bown
1
2 236 White D OUT 07

2
EV14 - COMP./TILT UP
1 241 Bown
1
2 231 White D OUT 21

2 1 241 White
1
EV3 - TANK OUTLET
2 262 Bown D OUT 01

2 1 241 Bown
1
EV15 - COMP./TILT DOWN
2 223 White D OUT 14
E

2 1 241 Bown
EV13 - PENDULAR ARM DOWN
B5 A5 1
2 224 White D OUT 06

B4 A4 2 1 241 Bown
EV11 - TELESC. RETRACTED
1
2 225 White D OUT 09
B3 A3
2 1 241 Bown
EV9 - UPPER ARM DOWN
B2 A2
1
2 226 White D OUT 04

2 1 241 Bown
B1 A1 EV7 - LOWER ARM DOWN
1
2 227 White D OUT 02
F
T1
T 2 1 103 White
SQ3 - PRESSURE STAT
1
2 119 Bown

2 1 241 Bown
EV17 - BASKET ROT. LEFT
B6 A6 1
2 222 White D OUT 12

2 1 241 Bown
B7 A7 EV1 - STEERING LEFT
1
2 234 White D OUT 15

B8 A8
2 1 241 Bown
EV19 - TURRET ROT. LEFT
1 2 221 White D OUT 08

80
2 1 241 Bown
EV18 - TURRET ROT. RIGHT
1 2 228 White D OUT 10

2
1 241 Bown
EV5 - STEERING RIGHT
1 2 229 White D OUT 16

2
1 241 Bown
EV16 - BASKET ROT. RIGHT
1 2 230 White D OUT 18

2
1 242 Bown
1 EV2b - BRAKE B 2 233 White

2
1 242 Bown
EV2a - BRAKE A
1 2 233 White

2
1 241 Bown
1
EV22 - RIGHT JIB ROT. 2 220 White D OUT 17

2
1 241 Bown
1
EV23 - LEFT JIB ROT. 2 219 White D OUT 11

To complete
base box
Ref. 5
547379EN
98 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS
- ITEMS 8, 9, 10, 11

Pos. Wire Colour


1 123 Pink
2 103 Dark Blue
6 1 3 244 Black
Wire Colour SENSORS 5 2 4 123 Red
123 Pink CONSOLE OUTPUT 4 3 5 103 Violet
HARNESS 6 117 Orange
103 Dark Blue
678476 - C
244 Black To Arm low sensors bundle
Ref. 11
123 Red (120 AETJL) - Ref. 14
telescope sensors harness
103 Violet
(120 AETJL) - Ref. 12
117 Orange or
123 Yellow To inductive sensors
intermediate harness
103 Green (150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL
245 Grey 170 AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49) - Ref. 12
123 Light blue
103 White Pos. Wire Colour
118 Brown 6 1 1 123 Yellow
2 103 Green
5 2
3 245 Grey
4 3
4 123 Light Blue
5 103 White
6 118 Brown

FLASHING LIGHT
To complete base box
Ref. 5
678389 - C To flashing light
Ref. 10 (option)
106

218

Pos. Wire
1 106
1 2 2 218

ALARM
HARNESS
678391 - D
80

Rep. 9
To audible alarm
123

217

Pos. Wire
1 217
1 2 2 123

TILT HARNESS
678392 - D
Ref. 8 To tilt sensor

123

103

109

Pos. Wire
A 103
B
B 123
A
C C 109
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 99

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS
- ITEMS 12, 13, 14, 15
Installation procedure:
- 120 AETJL
SQ4a
Pin Fil B B Pin Fil
A marron A A 123
A
B bleu C C B 103
C noir C 118

CAPTEURS
INDUCTIF

678901 - A
Rep. 13

SQ4b
Pin Fil
B
A 123
A
C B 103
C 245

FAISCEAU CAPTEURS FAISCEAU


BRAS BAS CAPTEURS
678883 - B TELESCOPE
Rep. 14 678864 - C
Rep. 12

B B
A A
C C

Pin Fil Pin Fil


A 123 A 123

80
B 103 B 103
1 6 1 6
C 244 C 117
SQ1b SQ1a 2 5 2 5
3 4 3 4

Pin Fil Pin Fil


1 123 1 123
B 2 103 2 103
A 3 244
C 3 245
4 123 4 123
5 103 5 103
6 117 6 118
Pin Fil
A marron
B bleu
C noir
Vers Faisceau
pupitre CAPTEURS
678476 - C
Rep. 11

CAPTEURS
INDUCTIF
678901 - A
Rep. 15
547379EN
100 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

- ITEMS 12, 13, 14, 15


Installation procedure:
- 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49

SQ4a

Pin Fil Pin Fil


B B
A marron A 123
A C A
B bleu C B 103
C noir C 118

CAPTEURS INDUCTIF
678901 - A
Rep. 13

SQ4b

Pin Fil
B A 123
A B 103
C
C 245

FAISCEAU
INTERMEDIAIRE
CAPTEURS
FAISCEAU CAPTEURS INDUCTIFS
BRAS BAS 678475 - C
678396 - C Pin Fil Rep. 12
Rep. 14 1 6 1 123
6 1
2 5 2 103
5 2
3 4 3 244
4 3
4 123
5 103
6 117

B B
C A C A
80

Pin Fil Pin Fil


A 123 A 123
B 103 B 103
C 244 C 117
SQ1b SQ1a

1 6 2 1 1 6
B 2 5 2 5
A 3 4 3 4
C

Pin Fil Pin Fil


Pin Fil
1 123 1 123
A marron
2 103 2 103
B bleu
3 244 3 245
C noir
4 123 4 123
5 103 Vers Faisceau 5 103
6 117 pupitre CAPTEURS 6 118
Rep. 11

CAPTEURS
INDUCTIF
SQ1b
678901
Rep. 15
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 101

80.3 ELECTRICAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT

80.3.1 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER


ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL

80 - 72 - Raise the arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 080 - 72) is raised
by 1 m (39.37 in).
1
-Turn the turret by 1/4 turn (2, 080 - 73)

- Switch off the power supply.

2 - Remove the cover (3, 080 - 74).


4
- Remove the battery protective casings (4, 080 - 72).
3

- Remove the cables connected to the charger from the battery


(680.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL, 5 137)

80 - 73 - Remove the cover plate (1, 080 - 73).


1
- Remove the charger (2, 080 - 73).

80
547379EN
102 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION

80 - 74
EXTERNAL VIEW
1
- Mains power supply cable..................................... (1, 080 - 74)
- LED indicator ............................................... (2, 080 - 74)
- Charging cables ...........................................................(3, 080 - 74)
2
6
- Auxiliary contacts ........................................... (4, 080 - 74)
5 7 - 5-pin plug.................................................... (5, 080 - 74)
4 - Capacity switch protective plug ......... (6, 080 - 74)
- Sticker: indication of settings (position of capacity switch) made
during first installation .................... (7, 080 - 74)
3

NOTE: ignore this sticker when configuring the settings for the
charger (6 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES,
5 104)

80 - 75
INTERNAL VIEW
3

- Input fuse F1 (1, 080 - 75): 20 A (see parts catalog)


2 3
- Output fuse F2 (2, 080 - 75): 45 A (see parts catalog)
6 4

- Fans .............................................................. (3, 080 - 75)

- Battery capacity switch C .......................... (4, 080 - 75)

- Input terminals ........................................................... (5, 080 - 75)

- Output terminals ........................................................... (6, 080 - 77)


80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 103

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS

80 - 76 - Auxiliary contacts to cut-off load movements: internal diagram


(see figure, 080 - 76).

NC C NO NC C NO

AUX 1 AUX 2

80 - 77
- 5-pin plug to connection the removed LED harness: external
2 diagram (see figure, 080 - 77).
5 4
3 1
BROWN
WHITE

GREEN LED RED LED

80
547379EN
104 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES

80 - 78 - Voltage curve:
U
Um

U1

I
- Amperage curve:
Im WUla
I1
IUla

I2

t
T1 T2 T3 STOP

- Properties:

Intensity: lm = 43 A I1 = 36 A I2 = 4% C5
Voltage: U1 = 57.6 V Um = 66 V
Other: C = C5

Type of charger IULa WULa


Ca pac it y switch
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
position
80

Capacity (Ah) 345 315 290 260 230 200 175 145 345 315 290 260 230 200 175 145

I2 (A) 138 127 115 104 92 81 69 58 138 127 115 104 92 81 69 58

Charging time IULa WULa


Capacity switch
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
position
10hr 7hr 6hr 5hr 4hr 10hr 7hr 6hr 5hr 4hr
T1max (h) 45min
10hr 9hr 8hr
15min 15min 30min 30min 45min
10hr 9hr 8hr
15min 15min 30min 30min
T2max (h) 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr
15hr 12hr 11hr 10hr 9hr 15hr 12hr 11hr 10hr 9hr
(T1+T2+T3)max (h) 45min
15hr 14hr 13hr
15min 15min 30min 30min 45min
15hr 14hr 13hr
15min 15min 30min 30min

CAUTION
The capacity Switch is to be configured based on the battery properties shown on the stick affixed to the battery.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 105

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATORS

80 - 79 LED charger indicator (see figure, 080 - 79)

- Red permanently on: initial charging phase.


100% - Yellow permanently on: battery at 80% charge.
- Green permanently on: battery at 100% charge.

80% 80% - LED flashing + intermittent audible signal from the charger: alarm
situation (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)
START

80 - 80
LED indicator removed (see figure, 080 - 80)
- Red permanently on: initial charging phase.
- Yellow permanently on: battery at 80% charge.
- Green permanently on: battery at 100% charge.

- LED flashing + intermittent audible signal from the charger: alarm


situation (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)

80
547379EN
106 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.3.2 IES BATTERY CHARGER

IES BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL


80 - 81

1 - Raise the arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 080 - 81) is raised
by 1 m (39.37 in).

-Turn the turret by 1/4 turn (2, 080 - 81)

2 - Switch off the power supply.


4
- Remove the cover (3, 080 - 81).
3

- Remove the battery protective casings (4, 080 - 81).

- Remove the cables connected to the charger from the battery


(680.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL, 5 137)

80 - 82 - Remove the cover plate (1, 080 - 82).


1
- Remove the charger (2, 080 - 82).

2
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 107

IES BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION


EXTERNAL VIEW
80 - 83
- Charging cables ...........................................................(1, 080 - 83)
- Mains power supply cable..................................... (2, 080 - 83)
- Auxiliary contacts ........................................... (3, 080 - 83)
1
- 5-pin plug.................................................... (4, 080 - 83)

4
2

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS

80 - 84
Auxiliary contacts to cut-off load movements: internal diagram
(see figure, 080 - 84).

NC C NO NC C NO

AUX 1 AUX 2

- 5-pin plug to connection the removed LED harness: external

80
80 - 85
2 diagram (see figure, 080 - 85).
5 4
3 1
BROWN
WHITE

GREEN LED RED LED


547379EN
108 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES

The charging current is selected automatically.

IES BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATOR

80 - 86 LED indicator removed (see figure, 080 - 86)


1 - Off: charger not powered
- Red permanently on: initial charging phase.
- Yellow permanently on: battery at 80% charge.
- Green permanently on: battery at 100% charge.

- LED flashing:
Yellow: battery balancing cycle
Red: alarm situation (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 109

80.3.3 ELECTRONIC MODULES - CONTROL AND SETTINGS

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS - REMOVAL

80 - 87 Base module control unit + safety control card

- Open the right-hand turret cover (1, 080 - 87).


1
- Open the front face of the base control panel (2, 080 - 87).

80 - 88 - Remove the plate holding the card in place (1, 080 - 88) and
remove the cards:
3
- Safety control card (2, 080 - 88).
2
1
- Base module control unit (3, 080 - 88).

80
80 - 89 Basket module control unit

- Remove the front face from the basket control panel (1, 080 - 89).
1

- Remove the basket module control unit (2, 080 - 89).

2
547379EN
110 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS DESCRIPTION AND WIRING


Base module control unit

80 - 90 80 - 91

C-NEG B+2
CAN A-IN D-OUT D-IN

1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4 5 6 5 6 7 8 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
B+
B-NEG D-NEG

LED RUN :
- ON, control unit powered.
- OFF, control unit switched off, defective or BUS-CAN problem.

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Notactivated Activated
1 243 +12V NOT MEASURABLE
2 0V NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
CAN
4 +12V NOT MEASURABLE
5 113 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
6 112 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
1 Free NOT MEASURABLE
2 Free NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
4 Free NOT MEASURABLE
A-IN
5 Free NOT MEASURABLE
6 Free NOT MEASURABLE
7 Free NOT MEASURABLE
8 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
C-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
D-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
80

1 215 JIB - Right Rotation Measurement to be performed using multimeter 0V


2 214 Arm 1/2 - Raised 2.6.1 Boom 1 up Open Closed 0V
3 213 Arm 1/2 - Lowered 2.6.2 Boom 1 down Open Closed 0V
4 212 Arm 3 - Raised 2.6.3 Boom 2 up Open Closed 0V
5 211 Arm 3 Lowered 2.6.4 Boom 2 down Open Closed 0V
6 208 Turret - Left Rotation 2.6.9 Slew left Open Closed 0V
7 207 Turret - Right Rotation 2.6.10 Slew right Open Closed 0V
8 205 Telescope - Retracted 2.6.7 Tele in Open Closed 0V
D-IN
9 206 Telescope - Extended 2.6.8 Tele out Open Closed 0V
10 201 Tilt - Raised 2.6.12 Cage level forward Open Closed 0V
11 202 Tilt - Lowered 2.6.13 Cage level reverse Open Closed 0V
12 209 Jib - up 2.6.5 Jib up Open Closed 0V
13 210 Jib - down 2.6.6 Jib down Open Closed 0V
14 204 Basket - Left Rotation 2.6.14 Cage rotate left Open Closed 0V
15 203 Basket - Right Rotation 2.6.15 Cage rotate right Open Closed 0V
16 216 JIB - Left Rotation Measurement to be performed using multimeter
B+ 106 +48V bat NOT MEASURABLE
B2+ 106 +48V bat NOT MEASURABLE
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 111

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Notactivated Activated
1 262 Tank return NOT MEASURABLE
2 227 Arm 1/2 - Lowered NOT MEASURABLE
3 239 Arm 1/2 - Raised NOT MEASURABLE
4 226 Arm 3 Lowered NOT MEASURABLE
5 238 Arm 3 - Raised NOT MEASURABLE
6 224 Jib - down NOT MEASURABLE
7 236 Jib - up NOT MEASURABLE
8 221 Turret - Left Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
9 225 Telescope - Extended NOT MEASURABLE
10 228 Turret - Right Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
11 219 JIB - Left Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
12 222 Basket - Left Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
D-OUT
13 237 Telescope - Extended NOT MEASURABLE
14 223 Compensation - Lowered NOT MEASURABLE
15 234 Steering - Left NOT MEASURABLE
16 229 Steering - Right NOT MEASURABLE
17 220 JIB - Right Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
18 230 Basket - Right Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
19 217 Horn NOT MEASURABLE
20 218 Flashing Lights NOT MEASURABLE
21 231 Compensation - Raised NOT MEASURABLE
22 233 Brake NOT MEASURABLE
23 Free NOT MEASURABLE
24 235 Pump NOT MEASURABLE

NOTE: When powered on, the LED flashes once, then switches on or remains off depending on the
results of the test phase.
- The operation of the base and basket fail-safes is checked using input 2.4.5 (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED
CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
- To check the inputs on the base control unit, it is imperative that the fail-safe button is pressed, then
proceed by holding down the movement selector.

80
547379EN
112 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Safety control card

80 - 93 80 - 92

OUT2
CAN B B+

1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
4 5 6 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
OUT1 B-

LED RUN :
ON, control unit powered.
FLASHING, fault on the overload circuit.
OFF, control unit switched off, defective, or BUS-CAN problem.

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN Wire N° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Not activated Activated
1 117 Arm 1/2 down - SQ1a 1.3.11 Boom rest Open Closed 0V (1)
2 244 Arm 1/2 down - SQ1b 1.3.17 Boom rest 2 Open Closed 0V (1)
3 118 Telescope retracted - SQ4a 1.3.12 Tele sw Open Closed 0V (1)
4 245 Telescope retracted - SQ4b 1.3.15 Tele sw 2 Open Closed 0V (1)
5 332 Overload - SQ5a 2.4.9 Cage over see overload _ (2)
6 333 Overload - SQ5b 1.3.16 Cage over 2 see overload _ (2)
7 Free NOT MEASURABLE
8 408 Return to overload validation 1.3.14 SFTY Rel Open Closed 0V (3)
9 Free NOT MEASURABLE
10 Free NOT MEASURABLE
11 Free NOT MEASURABLE
12 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B
13 Free NOT MEASURABLE
14 Free NOT MEASURABLE
15 Free NOT MEASURABLE
16 Free NOT MEASURABLE
17 Free NOT MEASURABLE
18 Free NOT MEASURABLE
19 Free NOT MEASURABLE
20 Free NOT MEASURABLE
80

21 Free NOT MEASURABLE


22 Free NOT MEASURABLE
23 Free NOT MEASURABLE
24 Free NOT MEASURABLE
1 NOT MEASURABLE
2 NOT MEASURABLE
3 NOT MEASURABLE
CAN
4 NOT MEASURABLE
5 112 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
6 113 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
OUT 1 406 Validation overload Ka11 0V
OUT 2 405 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B- 103 0V NOT MEASURABLE
B+ 106 +48V NOT MEASURABLE

1: 0 V in transport position only.


2 : ..............................(680.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 126).
3: Input must be in the “closed” state in order to obtain all movements.

NOTE: When powered on, the LED flashes once, then switches on or remains off depending on the
results of the test phase.
NOTE: There are no parameters for displaying the outputs, measurements must be taken with a multimeter.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 113

Basket module control unit

80 - 94 80 - 95

B+2
CAN A-IN D-OUT D-IN

1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 12 1 8
4 5 6 5 6 7 8 13 24 9 16

B+

LED RUN :
- ON, control unit powered.
- OFF, control unit switched off, defective or BUS-CAN problem.

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Not activated Activated
1 Free NOT MEASURABLE
2 Free NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
CAN
4 Free NOT MEASURABLE
5 112 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
6 113 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
1 315 Rotation set-point (%) 2.4.3 Y Axis Joystick % _ (1)
Rotation set-point V) 2.4.4 Y Axis Joystick Voltage _ (1)
2 318 Traction set-point (%) 2.4.1 X Axis Joystick % _ (1)
Traction set-point (V) 2.4.2 X Axis Joystick Voltage _ (1)
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
A-IN
4 Free NOT MEASURABLE
5 Free NOT MEASURABLE
6 Free NOT MEASURABLE
7 Free NOT MEASURABLE
8 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
C-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
D-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE

80
1 319 Fail-safe 2.4.5 Deadman Open Closed 0V (9)
2 312 Overload 1 NO NOT MEASURABLE _ (2)
3 311 Travel selection 2.4.10 Traction select Open Closed 0V (3)
4 313 Not neutral 1.3.18 Joystick NTRL sw Open Closed 0V (8)
5 332 Overload SQ5b NF 2.4.9 NOT MEASURABLE
6 316 Steering G 1.3.6 Steer left Open Closed 0V (3)
7 317 Steering D 1.3.7 Steer right Open Closed 0V (3)
8 306 JIB Rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V (3)
D-IN
9 310 Select arm 1/2 2.4.11 Boom 1 select Open Closed 0V (3)
10 309 Select arm 3 2.4.12 Boom 2 select Open Closed 0V (3)
11 304 Telescope selection 2.4.14 Tele select Open Closed 0V (3)
12 303 Jib selection 2.4.13 Jib select Open Closed 0V (3)
13 305 Compensation selection 2.4.16 Cage level select Open Closed 0V (3)
14 308 Basket rotation selection 2.4.17 Cage rotate Open Closed 0V (10)
15 307 Turret rotation selection 2.4.15 Slew select Open Closed 0V (10)
16 302 Horn NOT MEASURABLE 0V (3)
B+ 106 +48V battery NOT MEASURABLE
B2+ 106 +48V battery NOT MEASURABLE
547379EN
114 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Not activated Activated
1 325 Turret rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
2 328 Arm 1/2 NOT MEASURABLE 0V
3 327 Arm 3 NOT MEASURABLE 0V
4 322 Telescope NOT MEASURABLE 0V
5 321 Jib NOT MEASURABLE 0V
6 324 JIB Rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
7 323 Compensation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
8 326 Basket rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
9 Free NOT MEASURABLE
10 Free NOT MEASURABLE
11 Free NOT MEASURABLE
12 Free NOT MEASURABLE
D-OUT
13 329 Traveling NOT MEASURABLE 0V
14 331 Alarm/faults NOT MEASURABLE _ (4)
15 320 Buzzer NOT MEASURABLE _ (5)
16 330 Tilt NOT MEASURABLE _ (6)
17 NOT MEASURABLE
18 335 Overload ref. NOT MEASURABLE _ (7)
19 338 Maintenance alarm NOT MEASURABLE 0V
20 NOT MEASURABLE
21 336 Overload NOT MEASURABLE _ (7)
22 338 Tilt ref. NOT MEASURABLE not used
23 Free NOT MEASURABLE
24 Free NOT MEASURABLE

1 - (680.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS, 5 133)


2 - See overload settings (680.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 126)
3 - Keep the selection to measure the signal.
4 - Negative signal (0 V) intermittent: LED overload.
5 - Negative signal (0 V) intermittent if in tilt, continue if overload.
6 - Negative signal (0 V) intermittent (tilt LED + variable speed controller redundancy).
7 - See overload (680.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 126)
8 - Joystick in neutral position if parameter displayed is Open.
Each time the joystick is moved, the parameter turns to Closed.
9 - The operation of the base and basket failsafes is checked using input 2.4.5 (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED
CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
80

10 - Based on the position of the selector at the time of the check.

NOTE:
- When powered on, the LED flashes once, then switches on or remains off depending on the results of
the test phase.

- There are no parameters for displaying the outputs of the basket module control unit, measurements
must be taken with a multimeter.

ELECTRONIC MODULES - DIAGNOSTICS AND SETTINGS


(680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 115

80.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DESCRIPTION


Relay and fuse holder plate
80 - 96
3
- Power contacts:

1
2 - Line contact KM1 (A1-1) - Resistance ............. 46.1 Ω
- Electric pump KM3 (2, 080 - 96) - Resistance ............. 46.1 Ω
- Traction/pump motors KM2 (3, 080 - 96) - Resistance ............. 19.2 Ω

- Free wheel diode (4, 080 - 96) - Resistance ................................... 44 Ω


4
- Fuse of power circuit (4, 080 - 96): 325 A (see parts catalog)

80 - 97
Variable speed controller plate
2

- Variable speed controller (1, 080 - 97).

1 - Electronic module (2, 080 - 97).

- Fuse (3, 080 - 97): 100A (see parts catalog)


3

80
547379EN
116 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - WIRING


Control circuit - Electronic module

80 - 98 80 - 99

A B

1 2 3 1 6
4 5 6 7 12

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Type of signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Notactivated Activated
1 128 +10.5V Not used NOT MEASURABLE
2 128 0V NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
A
4 +10.5V Not used NOT MEASURABLE
5 113 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
6 112 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
1 106 Power supply Incoming
2 119 Pressure switch Incoming 1.3.13 Brake release Open Closed +48V
3 117 Arm down SQ1a Incoming 1.3.11 Boom rest Open Closed _ (1)
4 109 Tilt Incoming 1.3.10 Tilt Open Closed 0V (3)
5 108 Base selector Incoming 2.6.11 Lower box select Open Closed 0V (5)
6 118 Telescope retracted SQ4a Incoming 1.3.12 Tele sw Open Closed 0V (2)
B 7 Free
8 102 Line switch Outgoing 0V

9 130 Pump/traction switch Outgoing 0V (4)

10 Free
80

11 121 Switch KM2 Outgoing


12 +12V

1 - See operation of brake release electrical circuit.


2 - 0 V when the base/basket selector is set to base.
3 - 0 V in transport position only.
4 - 0 V only during hydraulic movements (except for travel, left/right steering, and supplying brakes).
5 - See tilt sensor settings for operating conditions (6TILT SENSOR - SETTINGS, 5 126)
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 117

Power circuit

80 - 100

D1

A1
Variable speed
controller plate +

-
F2
+
F1

B+ A

E1 E2 B- S

A2
A1

A1
A2
E1

80
Variable speed controller
E2 plate relay
547379EN
118 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DIAGNOSTIC AND ADJUSTMENT TOOLS


CALIBRATOR
CAUTION
The calibrator is also used for:
- The adjustment of the switches. (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
- Testing the manipulators. (680.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS, 5 133)
- Troubleshooting. (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)

80 - 101 Description
1
- Screen (1, 080 - 101).
SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR - Scrolling buttons (2, 080 - 101) (6VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS
2
- USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
- Incrementation buttons (3, 080 - 101) ( 6 VARIABLE SPEED
3 CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
- Connection socket (4, 080 - 101).
Controller A Controller B

4 Menu

Value - +

80 - 102

Fitting

1 - Open the right-hand turret cover (1, 080 - 102).


- Open the front face of the base control panel (2, 080 - 102).
2
- Identify the connection cable and attach to it the connection
socket (4, 080 - 101).
- Switch on the access platform.
- Adjust or check the variable speed controllers (6CONFIGURATION
80

MENUS, 5 121)

80 - 103
DIAGNOSTIC LED

- LED (1, 080 - 103).

- Status of LED and meaning (680.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS,


1
5 73)
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 119

BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR/HOUR METER

80 - 104
Description

- Screen (1, 080 - 104).


1 - Battery charge indicator (2, 080 - 104).
0% 100%
- Hour meter and variable speed controller fault display screen (3,
2
080 - 104).
Maintenance

h
P
T

3
SEVCON

80 - 105
- Connection socket (1, 080 - 105).

1 2 3
4 5 6
1

Operation (see instruction manual).

Connection

PIN Signal

80
1 Free
2 0V (masse)
3 +12V (back-lit)
4 +12V (power supply)
5 CAN_H
6 CAN_L

Error messages variable speed controller (6 80.1 ELECTRICAL


SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS, 5 73)
547379EN
120 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR

Structure of electronic module menu

- Configuration submenus:
Black text on white background (6CONFIGURATION MENUS, 5 121).
- Test submenus:
White text on black background (6TEST MENUS, 5 124).

SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR

SEVCON 1 Action SEVCON 2 Pump MENU LEVELS


OK OK Choice of menu:
CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR
left/right arrows
Menu validation:
down arrows
SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

2 Pump 2.2 Pump 2.2 Pump


SUB-MENU LEVELS Personalities Status Upper Box Pers

Choice of sub-menu: 4 5 22
PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS

SEVCON
left/right arrows
Validation of sub-menu and access
to list of parameters: CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

down arrows 2.4 Pump 2.5 Pump 2.6 Pump


Return to the menu list: Upper Box Test Lower Box Pers Lower Box Test
up arrows 15 17 15
PARAMETERS PARAMETERS PARAMETERS
SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

1.1 Traction 1.2 Traction 1.3 Traction 1.4 Traction


Personalities Status Test BDI
80

24 16 22 5
PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

1.5 Traction 1.5 Traction 1.7 Traction 1.8 Traction


Fault Log Setup Motor Setup Display
SEVCON
10 13 6
PARAMETERS PARAMETERS PARAMETERS
CAN CALIBRATOR

SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

PARAMETERS LEVEL 1.6.1 Trac Setup 1.6.2 Trac Setup 1.6.3 Trac Setup
Choice of parameter: CAN Mode Aboma Chop select On BDI On

SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON
left/right arrows
Modify parameter:

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR
+/- buttons
Return to the list of sub-menus:
up arrows

EXAMPLE
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 121

CONFIGURATION MENUS

Mini Maxi
Menu Traction Personalities Travel parameters Pitch Value
display display
1.1.1A Armature I Max (A) Armature limit current (A) 50 500 10 (*)
1.1.1F Field I Max (A) Field limit current (A) 10 50 1 50
1.1.2 Traction Accel Delay (s) Acceleration curve (s) 0.1 5.0 0.1 1.8
1.1.3 Traction Decel Delay (s) Deceleration curve (s) 0.1 5.0 0.1 0.1
1.1.3A Traction Direction Decel Delay (s) Deceleration curve current (A) 0.1 5.0 0.1 0.8
1.1.4 Traction Creep Speed (%) Zero speed (offset0) (%) 0 25 1 3
Braking regeneration current on flat
1.1.5 Flat Regen Direction Braking (A) 50 500 10 400
(A)

1.1.6 Tilt Regen Direction Braking (A) Braking regeneration current in tilt (A) 50 500 10 500

1.1.7 Traction Regen Time (ms) Recup time (mS) 0 300 10 10


1.1.8 Brake Threshold (V) Threshold voltage (V) 0.09 3.20 0.016 0.8
1.1.9 Traction Maximum Speed (%) Maximum speed (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.10 Elevated Speed (%) Working speed (%) 0 100 1 13
1.1.11 Tilt Speed (%) Tilt speed (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.12 Traction Cut 3 Speed (%) Speed limit 3 (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.13 Review delay (h) Maintenance intervals (H) 0 100 1 50
1.1.14 Customers Options Customizable settings 0 31 1 (+)
1.1.15 Low Speed Traction Speed (%) Slow speed (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.16 Low Battery Start (V) Low battery safe start (V) 14.5 48.0 0.5 18
1.1.17 Low Battery Cutout (V) Low battery cutout (V) 14.5 48.0 0.5 14.5
1.1.18 High Battery Start (V) High battery safe start (V) 14.5 75.0 0.5 65
1.1.19 High Battery Cutout (V) High battery cutout (V) 14.5 75.0 0.5 70
1.1.20 Battery Protection Level (V) Battery protection (V) 14.5 48.0 0.5 14.5
1.1.21 Battery Protection Delay (s) Battery protection delay (S) 0.1 2.5 0.1 0.5
1.1.22 Traction Alarm Battery alarm ON
(*) According to motor type.
(+) According to Beep option.

Menu Traction BDI Check Battery Charge Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.4.1 BDI Level (%) BDI battery charge level (%) / / / /
1.4.2 BDI Reset Level (V) BDI battery nominal voltage (V) 2.00 2.50 0.01 2.10
1.4.3 BDI Discharge Level (V) BDI Re enclenchement (V) 1.50 1.99 0.01 1.70
1.4.4 BDI Warning Level (%) BDI empty battery (V) 0 90 1 30
1.4.5 BDI Cutout Level (%) BDI Threshold warning (%) 0 90 1 20

80
Menu 1.5 Traction Fault Log Check Fault Log Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value

Menu Traction BDI Check Battery Charge Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.6.1 CAN Mode Configuration of CAN system Aboma

1.6.2 Chop Select Select voltage of digital output codes On

1.6.3 BDI Battery Charge Indicator On


1.6.4 Fault Log Fault log On
1.6.5 Service Log Manage fault log On

1.6.6 EU/US Functionality Select specific functionality Europe/US EU

1.6.7 Traction Full Speed (KPH) Traction Max. Speed (Km/h) 0 160 1 21
1.6.8 Traction Full Speed (MPH) Traction Max. Speed (mph) 0 100 0 13
Select type of accelerator curve
1.6.9 Accelerator Characteristic Centre-Pot
set-point
1.6.10 BDI Battery Voltage (V) Battery rated voltage (V) 24 96 2 48
547379EN
122 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Menu Traction Motor Setup Motor setup Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.7.1 Armature I Low (A) Armature low current (A) 10 240 10 90
1.7.2 Field I Low (A) Field low current (A) 5 25 1 6
1.7.3 Armature I Mid (A) Armature mid current (A) 90 400 10 200
1.7.4 Field I Mid (A) Field mid current (A) 6 40 1 25
1.7.5 Armature I High (A) Armature high current (A) 260 500 10 400
1.7.6 Field I High (A) Field high current (A) 25 50 1 40
1.7.7 Armature Resistance (mOhm) Armature resistance (mOhm) 0 255 1 13
1.7.8 Field Resistance (Ohm) Field resistance (Ohm) 0.25 2.50 0.01 1.26

1.7.9 Drive Proportional Gain Translation proportional gain 0 255 1 2

1.7.10 Drive Integral Gain Travel total gain 0 16 1 6


1.7.11 Brake Proportional Gain Brake proportional gain 0 255 1 40
1.7.12 Brake Integral Gain Brake total gain 0 16 1 15
1.7.13 Speed Estimate Gain Speed estimated gain 0 2.50 0.01 1.5

Menu Traction BDI Check Battery Charge Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.8.1 Display Default Hours Select hour meter to display Aboma
1.8.2 Display Status Type Select type of status data to display On

1.8.3 Display Contrast Set contrast level standard display screen 0 127 1 On

Select indicator 1 to display for advanced


1.8.4 FFD Indicator 1 On
display screen
Select indicator 2 to display for advanced
1.8.5 FFD Indicator 2 On
display screen

1.8.6 Display Fault Messages Validate display of default messages EU

Menu Pump Personalities Properties (hydraulic functions) Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
2.1.1 Pump I Max Pump max current (A) 50 500 10 350
2.1.2 Ramp Up Delay Ramp up time (S) 0.1 5.0 0.1 1.8
2.1.3 Ramp Down Delay Ramp down time (S) 0.1 0.5 0.1 0.5
2.1.4 Pump Creep Speed Speed (%) 0 25 1 10
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 123

Menu Pump Upper Box Pers Parameters Hydraulic Functions Average value Time target
Basket codes 120AETJL 150AETL/C 170AETJL 120AETJL 150AETL/C 170AETJL

2.3.1 Boom 1 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 1 & 2 100 17 45


2.3.2 Boom 1 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 1 & 2 42 65 26 45
2.3.3 Boom 1 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 1 & 2 100 100
2.3.4 Boom 2 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 3 telescope extended 73 70 67 24 38 48
2.3.5 Boom 2 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 3 telescope extended 42 38 30 24 34 36
2.3.6 Boom 2 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 3 100 100
2.3.7 Jib Up Speed (%) Speed jib lifting (%) 36 16
2.3.8 Jib Down Speed (%) Jib lowering speed (%) 20 18
2.3.8A Jib Rotate Left Speed (%) Jib left rotation speed (%) 1 1
2.3.8B Jib Rotate Right Speed (%) Jib right rotation speed (%) 1 1
2.3.9 Tele In Speed (%) Speed telescope retraction (%) 100 12 15 17
2.3.10 Tele Out Speed (%) Speed telescope extension (%) 100 24 19 23
2.3.11 Slew Left Speed (%) Speed left rotation turret (%) 29 23 26 80 88 120
2.3.12 Slew Right Speed (%) Speed right rotation turret (%) 29 23 26 80 88 120
2.3.13 Cage Rotate Left Speed (%) Speed left rotation basket (%) 24 7
2.3.14 Cage Rotate Right Speed (%) Speed right rotation basket (%) 24 7
Cage Level Forward Speed
2.3.15 Speed tilting bucket (%) 62 25
(%)
Cage Level Reverse Speed
2.3.16 Speed tilting spill (%) 28 25
(%)
2.3.17 Y-Axis Forward Voltage (V) Front travel voltage (V) 4.06 4.06
2.3.18 Y-Axis Reverse Voltage (V) Rear travel voltage (V) 0.52 0.52
2.3.19 X-Axis Left Voltage (V) Zero position (X-axis) voltage (V) 0.52 0.52
2.3.20 X-Axis Right Voltage (V) Max voltage (X-axis) (V) 4.06 4.06
Speed travel movement over 10 m (s) 100 8
Speed travel working over 10 m (s) 13 60

Menu Pump Lower Box Pers Parameters Hydraulic Functions Base Codes Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
2.5.1 Boom 1 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 1 & 2 0 100 1 100
2.5.2 Boom 1 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 1 & 2 0 100 1 90
2.5.3 Boom 1 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 1 & 2 0 100 1 100
2.5.4 Boom 2 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 3 telescope extended 0 100 1 100
2.5.5 Boom 2 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 3 telescope extended 0 100 1 70
2.5.6 Boom 2 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 3 0 100 1 25
2.5.7 Jib Up Speed (%) Speed jib lifting (%) 0 100 1 90
2.5.8 Jib Down Speed (%) Jib lowering speed (%) 0 100 1 75

80
2.5.9 Tele In Speed (%) Speed telescope retraction (%) 0 100 1 100
2.5.10 Tele Out Speed (%) Speed telescope extension (%) 0 100 1 100
2.5.11 Slew Left Speed (%) Speed left rotation turret (%) 0 100 1 60
2.5.12 Slew Right Speed (%) Speed right rotation turret (%) 0 100 1 60
2.5.13 Cage Level Forward Speed (%) Speed left rotation basket (%) 0 100 1 50
2.5.14 Cage Level Reverse Speed (%) Speed right rotation basket (%) 0 100 1 60
2.5.15 Cage Rotate Left Speed (%) Speed tilting bucket (%) 0 100 1 50
2.5.16 Cage Rotate Right Speed (%) Speed tilting spill (%) 0 100 1 50
2.5.17 Overload Cutback Speed (%) Overload speed limit (%) 0 100 1 50
547379EN
124 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

TEST MENUS

Menu Traction Status Status (Variable Speed Controller) Mini display Maxi display Pitch Log. Info
1.2.1 Battery Voltage Battery voltage 0V 127 V 0.1 +
1.2.2 Armature Motor Voltage Armature Voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.3 Field Motor Voltage Field voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.4 Armature Motor Current Armature current 0 625 A 0.20833333 +
1.2.5 Field Motor Current Field current 0 64 A 0.25 +
1.2.6 Armature MOSFET Voltage MOSFET voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.7 Controller Temp. Temperature variable speed controller -30 °C (-22 °F) +225 °C (+437 °F) 1 +–
1.2.8 Capacitor Voltage Capacitor Voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.9 Speed estimation Speed measurement 0 1 0.005
1.2.10 Speed estimation Speed measurement 0Km/H(0mph) 60Km/H(37.28mph) 1.0
1.2.11 Speed estimation Speed measurement 0 MPH 60 MPH 1.0
1.2.12 Key Switch Hours Count Hour meter operation 0 Hrs 65279.9 Hrs 0.1
Traction Pulsing Hours Count
1.2.13 Hour meter travel 0 Hrs 65279.9 Hrs 0.1
(Drive)
Output,
1.2.14 CAN fail node CAN fault note: 2 None n/a
EOutput
1.2.15 CAN error count CAN meter error - - -
1.2.16 CAN error code CAN coding error - - -
Service Log Reset RAZ memory faults Press + then - to reset Service Log

Menu Traction Test Variable speed controller Mini display Maxi display Pitch Log. Info
1.3.1 Accelerator % Accelerator % 0% 100% 1% range
1.3.2 Accelerator Voltage Accelerator Voltage 0.0 V 5.0 V 0.02 V range
1.3.3 Deadman Fail-safe Open Closed – Switch
1.3.6 Steer left LH steering Open Closed – Switch
1.3.7 Steer Right RH steering Open Closed – Switch
1.3.8 Horn Horn Open Closed – Switch
1.3.9 Traction select Traction select Open Closed – Switch
1.3.10 Tilt Tilt input Open Closed – Switch
1.3.11 Boom Rest Arm down sensor Open Closed – Switch
1.3.12 Tele sw. Extended telescope sensor Open Closed – Switch
1.3.13 Brake Release Brake sensor released Open Closed – Switch
1.3.14 BDI Input BDI Input Open Closed – Switch
1.3.15 Frame Fault Earth detection Open Closed – Switch
1.3.16 Cage Ovl2 Overload detection no. 2 Open Closed – Switch
1.3.18 Joystick NTRL sw Contact joystick not neutral Open Closed – Switch
80

1.3.19 LS Traction sw Select low speed traction Open Closed – Switch


1.3.20 Ver xxxxxxx Software version xxxxxx xxxxxx
1.3.21 Controller Serial Number Variable speed controller serial number 0 99999999 –
1.3.22 Controller type Power type xxnnn –

Menu Pump Status Variable speed controller (hydraulic functions) Mini display Maxi display Pitch Log. Info
2.2.1 Battery Voltage Battery voltage 0V 127 V 0.1 V +
2.2.2 Motor Voltage Motor Voltage 0V 127 V 0.5 V
2.2.3 Motor Current Motor Current 0 625 A 0.20833333 +
2.2.4 MOSFET Voltage MOSFET voltage 0V 127 V 0.5 V
2.2.5 Controller Temp. Microprocessor temperature -30 °C (-22 °F) +225 °C (+437 °F) 1 °C (33.8 °F) +–
Service Log Reset RAZ memory faults Press + then - to reset Service Log
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 125

Menu Pump Upper Box Test Test Hydraulic Functions Basket Codes Mini display Maxi display Pitch Type
2.4.1 Y axis Joystick % Joystick - Y-axis % 0 1 0.01 range
2.4.2 Y axis Joystick Voltage Joystick - Y-Axis Voltage 0.0 V 5.0 V 0.02 V range
2.4.3 X axis Joystick % Joystick - X-axis % 0 1 0.01 range
2.4.4 X axis Joystick Voltage Joystick - X-Axis Voltage 0.0 V 5.0 V 0.02 V range
2.4.5 Deadman Joystick - Deadman pedal Open Closed – Switch
2.4.8 Jib extension Jib detection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.9 Cage over Overload detection no. 1 Open Closed – Switch
2.4.10 Traction select Travel selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.11 Boom 1 Select Select arm 1/2 Open Closed – Switch
2.4.12 Boom 2 Select Select arm 3 Open Closed – Switch
2.4.13 Jib select Jib selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.14 Tele Select Telescope selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.15 Slew Select Turret rotation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.16 Cage Level Select Compensation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.17 Cage Rotate Basket rotation selection Open Closed – Switch

Menu Pump Upper Box Test Test Hydraulic Functions Basket Codes Mini display Maxi display Pitch Type
2.6.1 Boom 1 Up Arm 1 Lifting Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.2 Boom 1 Down Arm 1 Lowering Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.3 Boom 2 Up Arm 2 Lifting Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.4 Boom 2 Down Arm 2 Lowering Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.5 Jib Up Control jib raising Open Closed – Switch
2.6.6 Jib Down Control jib lowering Open Closed – Switch
2.6.7 Tele In Control telescope retraction Open Closed – Switch
2.6.8 Tele Out Control telescope extension Open Closed – Switch
2.6.9 Slew Left Control turret right rotation Open Closed – Switch
2.6.10 Slew Right Control turret left rotation Open Closed – Switch
2.6.11 Lower Box select Selection BASE controls Open Closed – Switch
2.6.12 Cage Level Forward Control forward compensation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.6.13 Cage Level Reverse Control backwards compensation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.6.14 Cage Rotate Left Control turret left rotation Open Closed – Switch
2.6.15 Cage Rotate Right Control turret right rotation Open Closed – Switch

80
547379EN
126 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS


SWITCHES - LOCATION
- (680.2.2 ELECTRICAL POWER COMPONENTS - LOCATION, 5 84)
TILT SENSOR - SETTINGS
CAUTION
The tilt sensors are pre-configured by the manufacturer.
The only parameter that can be adjusted is sensor initialization.

80 - 106 - Place the access platform on level ground and leave the power
switched on.
1
- Open the right-hand turret cover (1, 080 - 106).

- Locate the tilt sensor located between the base control panel
box and the counterweight.

CAUTION
Check that the angle of the sensor written in (2, 080 - 107) matches that of the manufacturer's plate
on the machine.

80 - 107 - Take the disconnected wire (2, 080 - 107) protruding from the
1 2 sensor.
3
- Take off the plastic cap (3, 080 - 107) at the end of the wire.
80

- Remove the right-hand battery protective cover (2, 080 - 107).

- Take an electric wire 0.5 m (19.69 in) long with its ends stripped,
WHITE 0V connect it to the wire (2, 080 - 107) and connect it to the – terminal
BROWN +24 V
YELLOW SIGNAL of the right-hand battery (3, 080 - 106):
Tilt <3° = 0 V
Tilt > 3° = No signal
- The green LED located under the sensor should flash several times.
- It stops when the sensor has initialized.
- It remains continuously lit.

CAUTION
During normal operation, the green LED is lit, and only switches off if the angular tilt value
is exceeded.

Checking
Tilt sensor Measure using the calibrator Authorized movements Multimeter
Audible signal
Tilt LED status Menu Description Message Transport position Working position Signal wire
Travelling Travelling
< 3° Lit None CLOSED 0V
1.3.10 Tilt switch Lifting/lowering Lifting/lowering
> 3° Not lit Intermittent OPEN Travelling None ~V
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 127

ARM DOWN SENSORS - SETTINGS


80 - 108 120 AETJL
-- Set the telescope to the down position, ensuring the control is
activated for as long as necessary, keeping the access platform
switched on.

1
ACCESS PLATFORM 120 AETJL
1 - Loosen the lock nuts (1, 080 - 108).
2 - Screw or unscrew the sensors (2, 080 - 108) until their LED, located
2
next to the power supply wire, switches from off to on (orange);
the clearance remaining between the support and the sensor is
approximately 3 mm (0.11 in).

- Tighten the lock nuts.

80 - 109 ACCESS PLATFORMS 150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D, 150 AETJL, 170
AETJL, AETJ 43, AETJ 43 3D, AETJ 49

-Remove the sensor protective covers from arm 3 (1, 080 - 109).
1

80 - 110 - Loosen the lock nuts (1, 080 - 110).

- Screw or unscrew the sensors (2, 080 - 110) until their LED, located
next to the power supply wire, switches from off to on (orange);
the clearance remaining between the support and the sensor is

80
1

1
approximately 3 mm (0.11 in).
2

2
- Tighten the lock nuts.

Checking
Retracted telescope sensor SQ4a Measure using the calibrator Multimeter
Telescope LED status Wire N° Menu Description Message Display
Retracted* Orange 118 Closed 0V
1.3.12 Tele sw
Extended Not lit 118 Open ~V

Retracted telescope sensor SQ4b Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Telescope LED status Wire N° Menu Description Message Display
Retracted* Orange 245 Closed 0V
1.3.15 Tele sw
Extended Not lit 245 Open ~V
* Access platform in transport position.
547379EN
128 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - CHECKING


CAUTION
The configuration of the pressure switch (1, 080 - 111) is hydraulic and not electrical (670.3.3 BRAKE
RELEASE CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING, 5 48)
This chapter does not deal with verification of the signals.

80 - 111

1 PF

Checking

Pressure switch SQ3 Measure using the calibrator Multimeter

Pressure in braking circuit Wire N° Wire N° Menu Description Message Display

0 to 25 bar* (0 to 362.59 psi) 119 119 Open ~V


1.3.13 Brake release
> 25 bar* (362.59 psi) 119 119 Closed 0V

* Based on pressure switch setting.

NOTE: in the absence of a signal from the brakes pressure switch (parameter 1.3.13 = open), the
electric pump is permanently active = incorrect operation of the access platform due to excess power
consumption of the batteries.
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 129

OVERLOAD SENSORS - SETTINGS

80 - 112
PROCEDURE

- Set the basket to the low position, keeping the access platform
switched on.
2

- Remove the cover (1, 080 - 112).

1 - Connect the calibrator to the access platform (680.3.4 VARIABLE


SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)

Overload spring pre-tensioning adjustment

- Place a load in the basket and distribute it evenly across the floor.
80 - 113
33 - 120 AETJL : 170 kg (375 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ43 - AETJ 43 3D : 170 kg (375 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL : 200 kg (441 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL : 170 kg (375 lbs)
1 1

2 2
- Tighten the bolt (2, 080 - 112) in such a way that it remains free
to rotate at the end of the operation with minimum play.
3 3
Overload sensor adjustment

- Undo the lock nuts (1, 080 - 113) then tighten the overload screws
(2, 080 - 113) to their maximum extent.

- Place a load in the basket and distribute it evenly across the floor.
33 - 120 AETJL: 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D : 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL: 250 kg (551 lbs)

80
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 230 kg (507 lbs)

- Sensor SQ5a: test menu 1.3.16


- Sensor SQ5b: test menu 2.4.9

- Identify sensor SQ5a (yellow ring on the power cable) and loosen
the overload screw (2, 080 - 113) until the calibrator displays OPEN
instead of CLOSED.
- Identify sensor SQ5b (yellow ring on the power cable) and loosen
the overload screw (2, 080 - 113) until the calibrator displays CLOSED
instead of OPEN.
547379EN
130 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Overload test

- Of the load still in the basket, take out 20 kg (44 lbs) and check that:

- The alarm switches off.


- The calibrator displays CLOSED in test menu 1.3.16 (SQ5a).
- The calibrator displays OPEN in test menu 2.4.9 (SQ5b).
- Replace the 20 kg (44 lbs), the alarm triggers (permanent tone), tighten the lock nuts (1, 080 - 113)
and put a paint mark on them to confirm the configuration.
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 131

SIMPLIFIED OVERLOAD WIRING DIAGRAM

Module Controle capt. sec.


Part N° 662/13124
Réf. CI678453

A5 : CAN-L
A6 : CAN-H

B+

B-

B02 : bras_bas_SQ1b
B01 : bras_bas_SQ1a
B03 : tel_rentré_SQ4a
B04 : tel_rentré_SQ4b
332 B05 : surcharge SQ5b
333 B06 : surcharge SQ5a
B07 : retour réduction vitesse
408 B06 : retour validation surcharge

Out_2 : retour vitesse


406 Out_1 : validation surcharge

(+ soft dédié)

MODULE CAN HIGH IO (Upper box)


Part N° 662/13130
Réf. CI677628 CAN6 : CAN-L
CAN5 : CAN-H

Di 16 : klaxon
Di 12 : sélection pendulaire
Di 11 : sélection télescope
Di 13 : sélection compensation
Di 08 : rot. JIB
Di 15 : rot. tourelle B+
Di 14 : rot. panier B+2
Di 10 : sélection bras 3 B/NEG
Di 09 : sélection bras 1/2 C/NEG
Di 03 : sélection translation D/NEG
332 Di 05 : surcharge SQ5a (circuit fermé)
Di 02 : libre 336
surcharge : Do 21
alarme maint. : Do 19
14 34 buzzer : Do 15
pendulaire : Do 05
SQ5b télescope : Do 04
compensation : Do 07
SQ5a 11 31 rot. JIB : Do 06
rot. tourelle : Do 01
Alimentation

80
Ai 01 : consigne rotation rot. panier : Do 08
des électrovannes bras 3 : Do 03
Di 06 : direction GH
Di 07 : direction DR bras 1/2 : Do 02
Ai 02 : consigne traction translation : Do 13
devers : Do 16
Di 01 : Homme mort
alarme/defauts : Do 14 331
Di 04 : Hors NEUTRE
Ref. surcharge : Do 18 335
Ref. devers : Do 22
241 A4

KA1

242

KA11 KA11 KA11

106 +48V
+48V
103
0V
0V
KA1 - Alimentation SQ5a/b - Capteurs H3 - Led H18 - Led
+48V des de surcharge surchage base surcharge panier
électrovannes
547379EN
132 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

OVERLOAD SIGNAL

- The reference of the overload signal is emitted by the basket card, output Do 18 (wire 335)................
(680.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS, 5 73)

U(V) 24V

Multimeter
reading
0.6V
t(s)

1s 1s
5s 5s

Calibrator OPEN OPEN


reading CLOSED CLOSED

MULTIMETER TEST

Overload sensor SQ5a Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


80

Weight in the basket Wire N° Menu Description Message To card Display

< 200 kg (441 lbs) 333 (F4) Safety (F4)


1.3.16 Cage Ovl 2
> 200 kg (441 lbs) 333 Open Safety No signal

Overload sensor SQ5b Measure using the calibrator Multimeter

Weight in the basket Wire N° Menu Description Message To card Display

< 200 kg (441 lbs) 332 (F4) Safety (F4)


2.4.9 Cage Ovl 2
> 200 kg (441 lbs) 332 Open Safety No signal
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 133

80.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS

MANIPULATOR - TESTS USING CALIBRATOR

CAUTION
The manipulator test from the basket base requires the presence of two operators.

- Connect the calibrator to the access platform and display test


80 - 114 menu 2-4 (6 80.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND
3
SETTINGS, 5 115)
2
- Switch on the access platform.
1

- Climb into the basket, then perform the following actions:

- Move the manipulator (1, 080 - 114) forwards and then backwards
without operating the trigger (2, 080 - 114).

- Press the upper left-hand button then the upper right-hand


button (3, 080 - 114) without operating the trigger.

- Operate the trigger (2, 080 - 114) on its own.

- For each action, check on the sub-menu in question the status of


the inputs/outputs at the neutral point, then when the manipulators
or switches are operated.

TEST

- Lastly, select menu 2-4-1 and 2-4-3 (UPPER BOX TEST) on the calibrator and check:

80
- That the proportional signal progresses steadily (i.e. from 0 to 100%).
- That it is at 0% in neutral and 100% only when the manipulator almost reaches its limit.

Manipulator test when lifting/lowering and travelling (Y)


Calibrator (measurement) Position of Joystick
Menu Description Front* Neutral Rear*
2.4.1 Y-axis voltage % 100 0 100
2.4.2 Y Axis joystick voltage 45 25 5
1.3.1 Accelerator % 100 0 100
1.3.2 Accelerator Voltage 45 25 5

* Manipulateur au maximum

Manipulator test with turret/basket rotation (X)


Calibrator (measurement) Position of Joystick
Menu Description Left* Neutral Right*
2.4.3 X Axis Joystick % 100 0 100
2.4.4 X Axis Joystick Voltage 0.5 2.5 4.5

* Manipulateur au maximum
547379EN
134 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

MANIPULATOR - TEST WITH A VOLTMETER

80 - 115
- Climb into the access platform with a voltmeter.

- Remove the front face from the basket control panel (1, 080 - 115)
1
and replace it.

- Locate the colored wires at the manipulator connector (see figure,


080 - 116).

- Take voltage measurements using the pins of the voltmeter,


placing them in contact with the clips crimped to each colored
wire at the manipulator connector.

80 - 116
OLD NEW
STANDARD STANDARD
GREEN GREEN (NOT NEUTRAL - MANIPULATOR)
YELLOW (X) YELLOW (X) (TURRET ROTATION CONTROL)
BLUE YELLOW/BLACK (LH STEERING PB)
BLACK GRAY/BLACK (RH STEERING PB)
GRAY (Y) GRAY (Y) (TRAVEL CONTROL)
PURPLE GREEN/BLACK (DEADMAN TRIGGER)
RED BROWN/BLACK (POWER SUPPLY - TRIGGER)
PINK WHITE/BLACK (POWER SUPPLY - STEERING PB)
Y 0V BROWN BROWN (GROUND)
X +24V WHITE WHITE (+ BATTERY)

Testing the analog outputs


- Move the manipulator (1, 080 - 114) forwards and then backwards without operating the trigger (2,
080 - 114) and check the values displayed by the voltmeter (see figure, 080 - 117).

80 - 117
80

Manipulator towards the LEFT Manipulator towards the


Turret rotation towards the LEFT FRONT - FORWARD
0V
Y
+24V 3W +48V

63V - 470µf
0.5V YELLOW (X) 4.5V GRAY (Y)
0 V BROWN
0 V BROWN

2.5 V YELLOW (X)22.22


2.5 V GRAY (Y)
0 V BROWN

NEUTRAL
0.5 V GRAY (Y) 4.5V ELLOW (X)
0 V BROWN
0 V BROWN

Manipulator towards the Manipulator towards the RIGHT


BACK - REVERSE Turret rotates right
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 135

Testing the logic outputs

- Press the top left-hand button followed by the top right-hand button (3, 080 - 114) without activating
the trigger, and check the values displayed by the voltmeter (see figure, 080 - 118).

80 - 118

ANCIENNE NOUVELLE
A. N. A. N. NORME NORME A. N. A. N.

24V Bl (D) J/N V BLEU (D) JAUNE/NOIR V Bl (D) J/N


V N (G) G/N V NOIR (G) GRIS/NOIR 24V N (G) G/N
R B/M ROUGE BLANC/MARRON R B/M
Ro B/N ROSE BLANC/NOIR Ro B/N
24V B B 24V BLANC BLANC 24V B B

Direction GAUCHE NEUTRE Direction DROITE

- Activate the trigger (2, 080 - 114) only alone and check the values displayed by the voltmeter (see
figure, 080 - 119).

80 - 119

ANCIENNE NOUVELLE ANCIENNE NOUVELLE


NORME NORME NORME NORME

V VIOLET VERT/NOIR 24V VIOLET VERT/NOIR


ROUGE BLANC/MARRON ROUGE BLANC/MARRON
ROSE BLANC/NOIR ROSE BLANC/NOIR
0V BLANC BLANC 0V BLANC BLANC

80
Gachette au NEUTRE Gachette ACTIONNEE

CAUTION
The “V”s mean that an uncertain voltage can be measured on the wire indicated.
“NS” means that there is no signal on the wire indicated”.
547379EN
136 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.4 ELECTRICITY REMOVALS - REFITTING

80.4.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - REMOVAL


80 - 120
- Raise arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 080 - 120) is raised by
1
1 m (39.37 in).

-Turn the turret by 1/4 turn (2, 080 - 120).

- Switch off the power supply.


2
- Disconnect the right-hand battery:
3

4 - Remove the right-hand battery protective cover (4, 080 - 120).


- Disconnect the - earth (1, 080 - 121).
- Disconnect the + (2, 080 - 121).

80 - 121
- Disconnect the left-hand battery, following the same procedure.

- Remove the cover (4, 080 - 120).

1
2

80 - 122 - Remove the cover plate (1, 080 - 122).


1
80

- Mark and then remove the harnesses connected to the variable


speed controllers (2, 080 - 122) (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS
- CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
2

- Remove the variable speed controllers.

2
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 137

80.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL


80 - 123
- Disconnect the right-hand battery:
1

- Remove the right-hand battery protective cover (1, 080 - 123).


- Disconnect the - earth (2, 080 - 123).
2 - Disconnect the + (3, 080 - 123).
3
- Disconnect the left-hand battery, following the same procedure.

80 - 124
- Remove the right-hand battery (see figure, 080 - 124), then the
left-hand battery:

33 - 120 AETJL : 220 kg (485 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL : 265 kg
(584 lbs)
33 - AETJ 43 - AETJ43 3D : 268 kg (591 lbs)

80
547379EN
138 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.4.3 ELECTRICAL HARNESSES - REMOVAL

A - Wiring based on the schematic diagrams (680.1.3 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 1ST
VERSION, 5 77)

CAUTION
In this chapter, all of the connectors are shown on the wire insertion side.
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 139

80.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL

80.5.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - FAULTS AND FIXES

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
Lit OK Traction operational and OK. No action required.
F05003 Internal Fault Variable speed controller Variable speed controller needs replacing.
F05004 12V Supply unusable.
Low
F05011 Drive 0 on
F05012 Drive 1 on
F05013 Drive 0 off
F05014 Drive 1 off
F05019 Stack
Corrupted
No message No power to variable speed - Check:
Not lit controller. • Battery voltage.
• Electrolyte-specific gravity by elements.
• The wiring of the batteries, polarities, and tightening of the terminals.
• The fuses.
• The emergency shutdowns.
• The battery cut-off.
• That the battery charger is not connected to the mains.
- Check:
• The battery connections (B-).
• The presence of the “+” battery on the “B1” input of the variable
speed controller logic (+24 V).
• The presence of the “+12 V” output of the B12 pin of the variable
speed controller: availability “+12 V” internal (pre-set).
1 Flash F04012 Pers Error Parameter outside valid range. The - Search for and fix the parameter where the following value is displayed
fault is removed by adjusting the “- - -”.
PARAMETERS value using the calibrator. - Switch the variable speed controller off and on: check the parameters.

F04013 CRC Error Checksum parameter value - Check: the value of all parameters.
incorrect. The fault is removed - Force the update of the CRC by changing any parameter.
by adjusting the value using the - Switch the variable speed controller off and on: check the parameters.
calibrator.
F05001 EEPROM Fault Parameters memory fault. - Check the value of the parameters.
2 Flashs F04003 Sequence Input(s) active when powered on: - Check that the input(s) are in the “CLOSED” status when switched on

80
Fault status “CLOSED”. in the following menus:
INCORRECT • Traction test (1.3).
INPUT • Upper box test (2.4).
SEQUENCE • Lower box test (2.6).
- Check the input(s) which are in error.
F04005 SRO Fault Sequence error: non-compliance - Re-start the start-up procedure for the required movement.
with the start-up procedure.
Sequence Variable speed controller internal - Measure the voltages on the “D-IN” connector inputs of the electronic
Fault or external fault. control units and “B” of the variable speed controller:
or • 0 V = Contact CLOSED.
SRO Fault • > (greater) than 4.5 V = Contact OPEN.
547379EN
140 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
3 Flashs F05009 PUp Trac MOS Failure of power test when - Check the following points:
switching on. • With the line switch (KM1) CLOSED, the voltage at terminal “A” of
MOSFET the variable speed controller must be equal to the battery voltage
(if no movement activated).
• With the line switch (KM1) OPEN, the voltage at terminal “A” of the
variable speed controller is around 7-8 V.

1 - If one of the two points above is correct, the problem originates


outside the variable speed controller. In this case, perform the following
checks (list not exhaustive):
• No negative voltage on the chassis.
• The electric pump must be isolated from the chassis.
• The electrical power harnesses must not be in short circuit.
2 - If any of the points described above is not proven, the
problem originates inside the variable speed controller. In this
case, perform the following checks.

2 - 1 - With the line switch (KM1) CLOSED, the voltage at terminal “A”
of the variable speed controller is <3 V:
• Disconnect the travel motor cables (terminal A, S F1 & F2 on the
variable speed controller).
• Switch the variable speed controller off and on.
• Check if the problem persists.
• Disconnect connector ‘B’ of the variable speed controller logic
module, connect a wire from plug “B1” of the variable speed
controller logic module to a positive battery.
• Switch the variable speed controller off and on.
• Check the status of the LED: if the problem persists, change the
variable speed controller or otherwise check the insulation of the
variable speed controller and the switch (KM3).

2 - 2 - With the line switch (KM1) OPEN, the voltage at terminal “A” of
the variable speed controller is <3 V:
• Internal fault in the variable speed controller, replace it.
F05006 Mosfet s/c Failure of power test - Turn off the machine: if the problem persists, repeat the procedure
when switching on described above
4 Flashs F05008 PUp Trac Weld Line switch (KM1)
- Check if the line switch (KM1) is OPEN when the power supply is cut:
“CLOSED” (stuck or welded) when
SWITCH OPEN
• KM1 OPEN: variable speed controller OK.
switched on: the variable speed
OR CLOSED • KM1 CLOSED: switch stuck, check the switch, check its power
controller measures a voltage on
supply and replace if necessary.
terminal “A” 2 volts less than the
- Check that there is a delay of 2 seconds between switching on and
battery’s rated voltage.
the closure of the line switch (KM1).
• DELAY = 2s: variable speed controller OK.
• Delay ≠ 2s: variable speed controller defective, driver of LINE
switch out of service.
80

- Check the power cables.

F05020 Line Cont O/C Line switch (KM1) - Check:


“OPEN”: the variable speed • The mechanical condition of the switch.
controller measures a voltage on • The coil of the switch.
terminal “A” 3 volts less than the • The control of the switch coil.
battery’s rated voltage. • The power and auxiliary fuses.
• The wiring of the motors.
- Check output B8 of the variable speed controller logic module, the
signal is negative, if this is not the case, the line switch driver is out of
service: change the variable speed controller.
F05021 Coil s/c (std) Digital output in short circuit on - Check:
the E/S module: BASE • The wiring.
• The elements controlled by the module.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 141

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
5 Flashs C_OVL Ssr Flt This fault is detected when there is - Check:
a fault on the overload sensors. • The status of the overload circuits.
FAULTS • The electrical circuit and connections.
SENSORS • Basket electronic control unit and safety electronic control unit.
F02004 C_OVL Sync This fault is detected when the - Check:
Flt two overload sensors are not in • The status of the sensors: parameters: 1.3.16 and 2.4.9.
the same status. • The overload settings.
• The electronic control unit and connections of the sensors.
• Basket electronic control unit and safety electronic control unit.
F02005 ElvTd Ssr Fault Signals an inconsistency between - Check:
the “working/travel” position • The settings of the “Working/Travel” position sensors.
sensors (telescope or arm 2/3). • The correct operation of the sensors.
• The electronic control unit and connections of the sensors.
• Logic module of the variable speed controller and safety
electronic control unit.

F05010 Bypass pump Fault switch KM3 stuck - Check KM3 switch
6 Flashs F02001 Accel. Fault Voltage fault in the joystick on one - Check:
of the X or Y axes. • That the joystick is activated when switched on.
ACCELERATOR Accelerator Value >20% on start- • The joystick supply voltage.
up for one of the X or Y axes. • The values of the manipulator parameters for each of the X and
Y axes.
• The configuration of the joystick potentiometer values.
• That the gray (Y) and yellow (X) harnesses of the joystick and
their connections are in good condition.
F02000 Accel. Fault Accelerator fault (out of range). - Check the manipulator, its wiring.
7 Flashs F04010 Battery High Battery voltage high - Check the correct operation of the battery charger.
on “High V cut” parameter.
VOLTAGE F04009 Battery Low Battery voltage higher than the - Check:
BATTERY “High V cut” parameter. • The state of the battery charge (voltage, electrolyte density, water
Battery voltage lower than the level).
“Low V cut” parameter. • The correct operation of the battery charger, its connectors.
Battery voltage lower than the - Put the access platform on charge.
“battery protection” parameter,
beyond the delay specified by the
parameter “protection delay”.
F01004 BDI Cutout Battery charge level lower than - Check:
“BDI CUTOUT” parameter. • The battery electrolyte-specific gravity.
• The condition of the battery cables.
• The tightening of the cable terminals.
• The BDI parameters.
- Put the access platform on charge.
8 Flashs F01005 Thermal The temperature of the power unit - Check:
Cutback is higher than 75°C (167 °F). • The operating conditions (motor overload, etc.).

80
TEMPERATURE • The tightening of the power terminals (motor, battery).
• The fitting of the variable speed controller plate on the chassis
(heat-conducting grease, etc.).
- Leave the variable speed controller to cool
9 Flashs F05000 Coil s/c The intensity of the current is - Check the current limit on the following digital inputs and outputs:
higher than the acceptable limit • 2A for the connector outputs of the variable speed controller
COIL for one of the following outputs: logic module (Plug 8 and 9 of connector B).
SWITCH - Coil of switch KM1. • 2A for the outputs of the connector “D-OUT” of the CAN
- Relay. electronic control unit of the BASE.
- Electrovalves. • 2A & 100 mA for the outputs of the connector “D-OUT” of the
- LEDs. CAN electronic control unit of the BASKET.
- Buzzer.
- Harnesses.
F05022 Coil s/c (ext) Digital output in short circuit on - Check:
the E/S module: BASKET • The wiring.
• The elements controlled by the module.
547379EN
142 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
12 Flashs F05005 Can Bus Fault There is no dialog between one or - Check for each of the electronic control units if their LED is
CANBUS more electronic control units. permanently on:
• If all of the LEDs are lit: perform tests §1-1 and §1-2.
• If at least one LED is switched off: perform test §2.

1-1 Tests to be performed 5 BUS-CAN connectors connected.


- Access platform switched on: measure the voltage between the
BUS-CAN wires and the negative (wire 103).

Theoretical voltage The signal must be


BUS-CAN wire
(V) between
112 ~2.4V 2.3V < < 2.7V
113 ~2.6V 2.3V < < 2.7V
- Access platform switched off: measure the resistance of the BUS-CAN
circuit between wires 112 and 113 at the diagnostics plug:
• The resistance is 95 Ω.

Theoretical resistance
Disconnect successively
between wires 112/113
Smart view 118 Ω
Base control unit 156 Ω
Safety control unit 235 Ω
Variable speed controller 470 Ω
Basket control unit ---
- Access platform switched off: for each of the electronic control
units, measure the resistance between the 112 and 113 inputs
at the CAN connector:
• The resistance is 470 Ω.

1-2 Tests to be performed 5 BUS-CAN connectors disconnected.


- Disconnect the BUS-CAN harnesses (wires 113 and 112) at each
end (variable speed controller, base electronic control unit, basket
electronic control unit).
- For wires 113 and 112, check the continuity between each of them and
each end: check that there is no continuity between wires 113 and 112.
- Check the connections, the shielding (variable speed controller
section - BASE box).
- Put the contact bomb on the BUS-CAN connections, bypass the
BUS-CAN lines with external wires to determine if the wires or
connections are defective.

2-Test to be performed if at least one LED is switched off


- Check when switched off if the LED flashes for 0.5 seconds:
80

• Check the power supply between terminals B+, B+2 (positive


terminals) and B/NEG, C/NEG, D/NEG (negative terminals) of the
control unit which is causing the problem.
• Check the connections of all power supplies mentioned above
- Check the quality of the battery negative signal: wire no. 103.
• Ensure that all of the connections of wire 103 are correctly
attached and connected (crimping of wires not damaged, quality
of contacts, etc.) in the electrical sockets, the terminal blocks, the
terminals, etc.
- Check the quality of the battery positive signal: wire no. 106.
• Ensure that all of the connections of wire 106 are correctly
attached and connected (crimping of wires not damaged, quality
of contacts, etc.) in the electrical sockets, the terminal blocks, the
terminals, etc.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 143

80.5.2 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - ERROR SIGNALS

SYMPTOMS CAUSES TO BE DONE IMMEDIATELY CAUSES TO CHECK


Output fuse and if the battery has
Acoustic signal + Battery disconnected or not Check the connection or the rated
been connected with the correct
RED LED flashing compliant. voltage.
polarities
Temperature probe disconnected Check the connection of the The voltage on the temperature
Acoustic signal +
during recharging or out of probe and measure the battery probe and measure the
YELLOW LED flashing
operational range. temperature. temperature of the battery.
Does the charge curve for the
Acoustic signal + Phase 1 and/or Phase 2 more than
Check the capacity of the battery. battery comply with that of the
GREEN LED flashing the maximum permitted.
battery charger?
Acoustic signal +
Loss of control of output current Logic control unit fault. Stage of reading current or shunt.
RED-YELLOW LED flashing
Stage of reading voltage or
Acoustic signal + Battery disconnected or fault on
Loss of control of output voltage resistance of reading voltage of
RED-YELLOW LED flashing logic control unit.
open battery.
Acoustic signal + An unavailable configuration has
Check the position of the selector.
YELLOW-GREEN LED flashing been selected.
Operation of the fan, fan pilot
Acoustic signal + Check the operation of the
Over-heating of semi-conductors. circuit, good connections with PTC
RED-YELLOW-GREEN LED flashing ventilation system.
sensor.

80.5.3 IES BATTERY CHARGER

SYMPTOMS CAUSES TO BE DONE IMMEDIATELY CAUSES TO CHECK


Battery temperature high Ambient temperature > 65°C
Disconnect the charger from the
Battery element in short circuit
mains Battery condition
RED LED flashing Power supply connector
Mains voltage
Disconnect/Reconnect the charger Select the voltages on the charger
Charge cycle greater than 20 hours
to the mains Charger defective

80
547379EN
144 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.6 SPECIFIC TOOLING - ELECTRICITY

80.6.1 CALIBRATOR

CAUTION
The calibrator is also used for:
- The adjustment of the switches.
(680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)131
- Testing the manipulators.
(680.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS, 5 133)138
- Troubleshooting.
(680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)160

80 - 125 DESCRIPTION
SEVCON 1
- Screen (1, 080 - 125).
CAN CALIBRATOR
- Scrolling buttons (2, 080 - 125) (6VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS
2 - USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
- Incrementation buttons (3, 080 - 125) ( 6 VARIABLE SPEED
3
Controller A Controller B
CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
4 Menu

Value - +
- Connection socket (4, 080 - 125).
80
GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY

00
TABLE OF CONTENTS

00.1 GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS AND SAFETY NOTICE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

00.1.1 INTRODUCTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

00.1.2 SERVICING POSITION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 8

00.1.3 EXPLANATION OF SYMBOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 9

00.1.4 SERVICING RULES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 10

00.2 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

00.2.1 CHARACTERISTICS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

00.2.2 LUBRICANTS AND FUEL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 13

00.2.3 DIMENSIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14

DIMENSIONS 120AETJL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 14

DIMENSIONS 150AETJC - AETJ 43 - AETJC 43 3D . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 16

DIMENSIONS 150AETJL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 18

DIMENSIONS 170AETJL - 49 AETJC . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 20

00.2.4 LOCATION OF NAME AND IDENTIFICATION PLATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

ACCESS PLATFORM MANUFACTURER’S PLATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

LOCATION OF MANUFACTURER'S PLATE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . .

120 AETJ . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 22

00.3 GENERAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23

00.3.1 STANDARD TIGHTENING TORQUES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 23

00.3.2 METRIC - IMPERIAL UNIT CONVERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 24


547379EN
8 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY

00.1 GENERAL INSTRUCTIONS AND SAFETY NOTICE

00.1.1 INTRODUCTION

This chapter deals with the general instructions and safety notice during inspection and maintenance
work.
Other instructions and warnings are indicated in each chapter concerned.

In order to reduce accident risks, make sure to:

– Follow the instructions in the truck operating and maintenance manual.


⇒ This manual should be found in all trucks.
– Please follow all safety instructions.
– Use the appropriate tools for any work to be performed.
– Use original Manitou spare parts.

Any non-compliance increases the risk of accidents occurring which may lead to causing grievous bodily
harm and even death.

An efficient, dependable and profitable combination will be formed if the operator follows the safety
manual correctly and the machine is serviced properly.
00.1.2 SERVICING POSITION

Before any intervention:

1 - Place the machine on a flat surface and chock the wheels.


2 - Turn off the engine and remove the ignition key.
3 - Let the machine cool down.
4 - Take all the pressure out of the circuits concerned.
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 9

00
00.1.3 EXPLANATION OF SYMBOLS

The symbols shown below are used to warn of potential hazards as well as to provide useful information
concerning a procedure.

SYMBOLE OBSERVATION

Indicates an imminent hazardous situation which, if not avoided


DANGER will result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided,


WARNING may result in death or serious injury.

Indicates a potentially hazardous situation which, if not avoided,


CAUTION may result in minor injury or damage to property. It is also used to
warn users of unsafe practices.

TIP Indicates a tip to facilitate the performance of a procedure.

Indicates a message to draw attention to important information


PROTECT THE ENVIRONMENT regarding environmental protection.

SPECIFIC TOOLING Indicates special tools for performing a task.

4 "SEE": Indicates a cross-reference to a manual.

5 “SEE”: Indicates a cross-reference to a page.

0 “SEE”: Indicates a cross-reference to a picture.

"WEIGHT": Indicates the weight of an item.


3 (E.g.: it helps to anticipate an action linked to a person's health or the
choice of lifting equipment)

2 "TIGHTENING TORQUE": Indicates the value of tightening torque


to be applied.

1 "OPTION": Indicates the presence of an option.

The manufacturer cannot predict all possible risky situations. Consequently, the safety instructions
given in the manual are not exhaustive.
At any time, as an operator, you must consider, within reason, the possible risk to yourself, to others
or to the lift truck itself when you repair, service or drive it.

Manitou cannot be held responsible for the use of any lifting devices, tools or operating methods other
than those specified.
547379EN
10 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

00.1.4 SERVICING RULES

Do not carry out any work on the machine unless you have
followed a suitable training course and have the knowledge
required for it.

4 Make sure you have taken into consideration all the indicator
plates on the machine and in the instruction manual.

PRÉCAUTION
Be careful not to burn yourself when touching hot liquids or parts when
operations have to be done before the machine has had time to cool down.

AVERTISSEMENT
1 Before carrying out any operation on an electrically powered component,
activate the battery cut-off.
2
PRÉCAUTION
Press the battery switch at least 30 seconds after disconnecting the electrical
contact with the ignition key.

AVERTISSEMENT
If the telehandler does not have a battery isolating switch, disconnect the
battery terminals then gather them.

PRÉCAUTION
ECU
Before carrying out any welding operations, think of disconnecting computers.

PRÉCAUTION

A machine operating in a contaminated environment should be specifically


equipped. Moreover, local safety notices deal with maintenance and repair
work on such machines.
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 11

00
AVERTISSEMENT
Never step on a part of the machine that has not been designed for it.

AVERTISSEMENT
Never wear clothes, jewelry or objects that could get caught during work and
cause accidents.

Always wear protection glasses, gloves, safety shoes as well as any other
protection required for the work to be carried out.

DANGER
When carrying out maintenance
operations near a mobile object,
make sure it is securitized.

PROTÉGER L’ENVIRONNEMENT

When changing, or draining oils or fuel, or any other operation with liquids,
solids, gases that are harmful to the environment, make sure the necessary
precautions are taken to avoid contaminating the environment.
547379EN
12 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DANGER

When lifting or shoring a component of the machine, make sure the equipment
used is suitable for at least the load for which it is subjected by the component
and that it meets the national standards for lifting devices.

When using a jack, make sure it is used on a flat, uniform surface, is sturdy
enough to support the load, that its lifting capacity is sufficient and that it is
correctly placed and positioned under the machine.

PRÉCAUTION

Make sure no object or tool which could cause an accident is left in the machine.

AVERTISSEMENT
Never control any leaks using a hand.

max.

min.
PRÉCAUTION
MAX Never adjust a component to over the maximum capacity indicated by the
manufacturer.

MIN
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 13

00
00.2 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS

00.2.1 CHARACTERISTICS
Designation 120 AETJL 150 AETJC 150 AETJC 3D 150 AETJL 170 AETJL AETJ 43 AETJ 43 3D AETJ 49
5050 kg 6700 kg 6760 kg 5910 kg 6910 kg 7100 kg 7160 kg 7105 kg
Unladen weight of carriage
(11,133 lbs) (14,771 lbs) (14,904 lbs) (13,030 lbs) (15,234 lbs) (15,653 lbs) (15,785 lbs) (15,684 lbs)
1185 kg 1465 kg 1465 kg 1240 kg 1534 kg 1555 kg
FRONT - -
Unladen pneumatic (2,613 lbs) (3,230 lbs) (3,230 lbs) (2,734 lbs) (3,389 lbs) (3,428 lbs)
load 1340 kg 1885 kg 1885 kg 1715 kg 1921 kg 1992.5 kg
REAR - -
(2,954 lbs) (4,156 lbs) (4,156 lbs) (3,781 lbs) (4,325 lbs) (4,393 lbs)
Nominal capacity 200 kg 200 kg 200 kg 230 kg 200 kg 227 kg 227 kg 227 kg
(2 people) (441 lbs) (441 lbs) (441 lbs) (507 lbs) (441 lbs) (500 lbs) (500 lbs) (500 lbs)

00.2.2 LUBRICANTS AND FUEL

Designation Type Quantity


18 ℓ
Hydraulic tank MANITOU ISO VG 46 Hydraulic oil
(4.76 US gallons)
0.8 ℓ
Wheel motor (each) (0.21 US gallons)
SHELL SPIRAX A90 oil
Turret rotation motor 1.5 ℓ
(0.40 US gallons)
General greasing SHELL RETINAX HD grease -
Greasing of turret crown of
Grease SHELL ALVANIA EP LF 2 -
bearing track
Lubrication of turret crown
SHELL MALLEUS GL 205 oil -
gear teeth
547379EN
14 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

00.2.3 DIMENSIONS
DIMENSIONS 120AETJL

mm ft-in
A 5520 18-1.3
A1 3930 12-10.7
B 2000 6-6.7 F
C 1995 6-6.5 H
C1 2210 7-3.0
D 1500 4-11.1
E 153 0-6.0
F 2640 8-8.0
G 1870 6-1.6
H 3960 12-11.9
I 4520 14-9.9
G

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 15

00
mm ft-in mm ft-in

G1 2350 7-8.5 H1 9950 32-7.7

G2 3105 10-2.2 H2 8795 28-10.3

G3 6370 20-10.8 H3 4775 15-8.0

G4 5640 18-6.0 H4 545 1-9.5

3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7

13

12
G1
11

10
H1

G2
H2

G3
H3

G4 2

1
H4

3 2 2 3 4 5 6 7
547379EN
16 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DIMENSIONS 150AETJC - AETJ 43 - AETJC 43 3D

mm ft-in
A 6050 19-10.2
A1 4400 14-5.2
B 2000 6-6.7
C 1965 6-5.4
C1 2080 6-9.9 F
D 1500 4-11.1 H
E 143 0-5.6
F 2640 8-7.9
G 1870 6-1.6
H 3960 12-11.9
I 4820 15-9.7

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 17

00
mm ft-in mm ft-in

G1 2665 8-8.9 H1 12985 42-7.2

G2 3425 11-2.8 H2 11835 38-9.9

G3 7105 23-3.7 H3 7165 23-6.1

G4 6300 20-8.0 H4 235 0-9.2

3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

16

15

G1
14

13
H1

12

G2
H2

11

10

7
G3
H3

2
G4

1
H4

3 2 2 3 7 8 9
547379EN
18 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DIMENSIONS 150AETJL

mm ft-in
A 5960 19-6.6
A1 4400 14-5.2
B 2000 6-6.7
C 1970 6-5.5
C1 2080 6-9.9
F H
D 1750 5-8.9
E 143 0-5.6
F 2880 9-5.4
G 1970 6-5.6
H 4270 14-0.1
I 4890 16-0.5

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 19

00
mm ft-in mm ft-in

G1 2660 8-8.7 H1 13275 43-6.6

G2 3420 11-2.6 H2 12120 39-9.1

G3 7310 23-11.8 H3 7165 23-6.1

G4 6500 21-3.9 H4 205 0-8.1

3 2 1 0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9

16

15
G1

14

13
H1

12

G2
H2

11

10

7
G3
H3

2
G4

1
H4

3 2 2 3 5 8 9
547379EN
20 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

DIMENSIONS 170AETJL - 49 AETJC

mm ft-in
A 6840 22-5.3
F H
A1 5120 16-9.6
B 2000 6-6.7
C 1970 6-5.6
C1 2040 6-8.3
D 1750 5-8.9
E 140 0-5.5
F 2890 9-5.8
G 2005 6-6.9
H 4300 14-1.3 G
I 5600 18-4.5

I
C1
C

B D
A1
A
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 21

00
mm ft-in
G1 2840 9-3.8
G2 3600 11-9.7
G3 8930 29-3.6
G4 8130 26-8.1
H1 14905 48-10.8
H2 13750 45-1.3
H3 7160 23-5.9
H4 270 0-10.6 

             


































       
547379EN
22 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

GENERAL LOCATION
00.2.4 LOCATION OF NAME AND IDENTIFICATION PLATE
As our policy is one of constant improvement of our products, our range of access platforms may undergo
certain modifications, without obligation for us to advise our customers.
When you order parts, or when you require any technical information, always specify:
NOTE: For the owner's convenience, it is recommended that a note of these numbers is made in the
spaces provided, at the time of the delivery of the access platform.
1-1
ACCESS PLATFORM MANUFACTURER’S PLATE

Type:
Serial no.:
Year of manufacture:

1-2
LOCATION OF MANUFACTURER'S PLATE 120 AETJ
The manufacturer's plate is fitted on the inside right panel of the
turret.

1-3
LOCATION OF MANUFACTURER'S PLATE
150 AETJC - AETJ43 - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ43 3D
150 AETJL - AETJ49
170 AETJ L

The manufacturer's plate is fitted on the left rear side of the chassis.
547379EN
00 (08/03/2017) GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 23

00
00.3 GENERAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT

b
00.3.1 STANDARD
STANDARD TIGHTENING
TIGHTENING TORQUESTORQUES
(N.m & lb-in))
Standard tightening torques
To be used. unless otherwise indicated in the removal or refit operations.
SCREW / NUT ASSEMBLY
- with hexagon head screws without flanges ou cylinder head hexagon socket screws.
- for dry-fitted zinc-plated fasteners and for torque tools having a ± 20 % class C tightening torque
accuracy (equivalent to pneumatic screwdrivers).
1 - NF E 25-030-1 :
Ø x “coarse” pitch Grade 8.8 Grade 10.9 Ø x “fine” pitch Grade 8.8 Grade 10.9
N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in
M6 x 1 8.2 72.57 12.1 107 - - -
M8 x 1.25 20 177 30 265 M8 x 1 22 195 32 283
M10 x 1.5 40 354 59 522 M10 x 1.25 (x 1) 43 (46) 380 (407) 63 (68) 558 (602)
M12 x 1.75 69 611 102 903 M12 x 1.5 (x 1.25) 74 (78) 655 (690) 108 (115) 956
M14 x 2 111 982 163 1443 M14 x 1.5 123 1088 181 1602
M16 x 2 175 1549 256 2266 M16 x 1.5 190 168 279 2470
M18 x 2.5 240 2124 352 3115 M18 x 1.5 279 2469 410 3629
M20 x 2.5 341 3018 501 4434 M20 x 1.5 391 3460 574 5080
M22 x 2.5 470 4160 691 6116 M22 x 1.5 531 4700 780 6903
M24 x 3 588 5204 864 7647 M24 x 2 659 5833 967 8559
M27 x 3 874 7735 1284 11364 M27 x 2 965 8541 1418 12550
M30 x 3.5 1181 10453 1735 15356 M30 x 2 1351 11957 1984 17560
M33 x 3.5 1614 14285 2371 20985 M33 x 2 1821 16117 2674 23667

b
M36 x 4 2068 18303 3037 26880 - - -

For hexagon screws with flanges (NF E 25-030-1) :


Apply an increased torque of +10%.

b Where washers are used. the following coefficient is to be applied (FD E 25-502) :
- Plate : +0% - Spring (or Grower) washer without jaws (W) : +10%
- Smooth tapered washer (CL): +5% - Conical. internal teeth (CDJ-JZC) : +15%.
2 - With marking :

4 5 6 7 8
4T 6T 8T
------------ ------------ ------------

5T
(N.m)
7T
(N.m)
11
(flange : 4.8T) (flange : 6.8T) (flange : 8.8T) (flange : 10.9T) (flange : 11.9T)
Ø x Pitch N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in N.m lb-in
5.4 48 7.8 69 12 106
M6 x 1 6.5 57.5 11 97 (15.5) (137.2) (17.5) (155)
(5.5) (49) (7.5) (66) (12) (106)
13 115 19 168 29 257
M8 x 1.25 16 142 25 221 (38) (336) (42) (372)
(13) (115) (19) (168) (29) (257)
25 221 39 345 61 540
M10 x 1.25 32 283 52 460 (80) (708) (89) (788)
(27) (239) (39) (345) (61) (540)
47 416 72 637 108 956
M12 x 1.25 59 522 95 841 (145) (1283) (160) (1416)
(50) (443) (71) (628) (110) (974)
75 664 108 956 172 1522
M14 x 1.5 91 805 147 1301 (230) (2036) (260) (2301)
(78) (690) (110) (974) (175) (1549)

b
113 1000 172 1522 265 2345
M16 x 1.5 137 1213 226 2000 (360) (3186) (400) (3540)
(120) (1062) (170) (1504) (270) (2390)

use the upper class where spring (or Grower) washers are used.
547379EN
24 GENERAL CHARACTERISTICS AND SAFETY 00 (08/03/2017)
00

00.3.2 METRIC - IMPERIAL UNIT CONVERSION


RULES
-The tolerance has the same unit as the value and is not a percentage :
Example : 120 ± 12 Ω , not 120 ± 10 %.
-The unit is separated from the value by a space and placed after the tolerance :
Example: 120 Ω ou 120 ± 12 Ω except for angle degrees : 40° ou 40 ± 3°.
-The conversion of some marks is not possible :
Example: thread of a screw : M12x1.75.
-Use decimals to convert precise values :
Example: 190 mm = 7.48 in.
-Write lengths in feet-inches format:
Example: 20 m = 65 ft 7.4 in or in a table 20 (m) = 65-7.4 (ft-in).
CONVERSION COEFFICIENTS:
Metric Unit (S.I) Coefficient Imperial Unit US
° (angle degree) x 1 = ° (angle degree)
°C (Celsius degree) x 1.8 + 32 = °F (Fahrenheit degree)
cv (cheval vapeur) x 0.9859 = hp (horsepower)
bar (bar) x 14.51 = psi (pound-force/square inch)
g (gram) x 0.0353 = oz av (ounce avoirdupois) (oz : lat. onza)
Hz (Hertz) x 1 = Hz (Hertz)
kg (kilogram) x 2.2046 = lb (pound) (lat . libra)
kg (kilogram) x 35.274 = oz av (ounce avoirdupois) (oz : lat. onza)
km/h (kilometer per hour) x 0.6214 = mph (miles per hour)
kW (kilowatt) x 1.34048 = hp (horsepower)
ℓ (liter) x 0.2642 = gal US (US gallon)
ℓ (liter) x 1.0567 = qt US (quart US gallon)
m (meter) x 3.2808 = ft (foot)
m (meter) x 39.37 = in (inch)
min (minute) x 1 = min (minute)
mℓ (milliliter) x 0.0338 = fl oz (fluid ounce) (fl : fluid, oz : lat. onza)
mm (millimeter) x 0.03937 = in (inch)
µm (micrometer) x 0.03937 = mil (thousands of an inch)
N (Newton) x 0.2248 = lbf (pound-force) (lb : lat. libra, f : force)
N.m (Newton meter) x 0.7376 = ft-lb (pound-force-foot) (ft : foot, lb : lat. libra)
N.m (Newton meter) x 8.8507 = lb-in (pound-force-inch) (lb : lat. libra, in : inch)
s (second of time) x 1 = s (second of time)
rad/s (radian/second) x 9.5493 = rpm (revolution per minute)
t (metric ton) x 2204.62 = lb (pound) (lat. libra)
tr/min (tour per minute) x 1 = rpm (revolution per minute)
Ω (Ohm) x 1 = Ω (Ohm)
Other unit conversions Coefficient
ft (foot) x 12 = in (inch)
lb (pound) (lat . libra) x 16 = oz av (ounce avoirdupois)
m (meter) x 1000 = mm (millimeter)
µm (micrometer) x 0.001 = mm (millimeter)
t (metric ton) x 1000 = kg (kilogram)
° (angle degree) x 0.01745 = rad (radian)
Abbreviation
lat: Latin
gr: Greek
AXLE

TABLE OF CONTENTS

30.1 CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27

30.1.1 REAR AXLE - OPERATION IN FREEWHEEL MODE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 27

30
547379EN
26 AXLE 30 (08/03/2017)
30
547379EN
30 (08/03/2017) AXLE 27

AXLE

30.1 CHARACTERISTICS AND SPECIFICATIONS

30.1.1 REAR AXLE - OPERATION IN FREEWHEEL MODE


DANGER
In order to operate the access platform in freewheel mode, it should not be subjected to translational
constraints resulting from a slope.
When the access platform is in the freewheel mode, it can move freely: fit wedges to immobilize the wheels.

CAUTION

30
If the access platform needs to be towed, this operation should only be carried out:
- Over short distances.
- Necessarily by a machine that has high braking power in order to hold it steady, and at a slow speed.
- By means of a connecting bar between the two machines.

30 - 4 - IF POSSIBLE, lift the rear of the platform (1, 030 - 4).

33 120 AETJL : 2680 kg (5908 lbs)


2
33 150 AETJC : 3770 kg (8311 lbs)
33 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D : 3375 kg (7441 lbs)
33 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 3842 kg (8470 lbs)
33 AETJ43 - AETJ43 3D : 3775 kg (8322 lbs)

- Locate the screws (2, 030 - 4).


2
1

30 - 5 - Unscrew these screws according to the model of your platform,


030 - 5) by 22 mm (0.87 in), up to the hard spot and without forcing:
150 N.m RISK OF BREAKAGE.
22 Maximum loosening torque 20 N.m (177 lb-in).
2 - Set the platform down.
20 N.m - The machine can now be towed.
22 mm RESETTING
1
- Raise the rear of the platform.
- Turn the wheels from left to right and reset the gears by re-
tightening the screws (2, 030 - 5):
22 Maximum tightening torque for rear wheel 150 N.m (1327.6  lb-in)

15 daNm
JIB - BASKET

TABLE OF CONTENTS

55.1 JIB - BASKET CONTROLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2 JIB - BASKET REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2.1 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2.2 REMOVAL OF REAR PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 31

55.2.3 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPE MOVING TUBE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 32

55
547379EN
30 JIB - BASKET 55 (08/03/2017)
55
547379EN
55 (08/03/2017) JIB - BASKET 31

JIB - BASKET

55.1 JIB - BASKET CONTROLS

55.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE


CLEARANCE between moving tube and arm of telescope
Lateral 0.5 mm (0.02 in)
Upper 0.5 mm (0.02 in)

If necessary, add the adjustment plates if necessary (see parts catalogs).

55.2 JIB - BASKET REMOVAL

55.2.1 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER


55 - 6 Remove the telescopic cylinder (6TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL,
5 63)
Remove and replace the pads (1, 055 - 6) (see parts catalog).

55
1

55.2.2 REMOVAL OF REAR PADS OF TELESCOPIC CYLINDER


55 - 7 - Remove the telescopic cylinder (6TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL,
5 63).

1
- Release the pads (1, 055 - 7) by slightly raising the basket.

- Remove the pads (1, 055 - 7), pay attention to the position and
number of adjustment plates.

- Get new pads (see parts catalog)


1 - Replace the pads and adjustment plates, then check the clearance
(655.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE, 5 31).
547379EN
32 JIB - BASKET 55 (08/03/2017)

55.2.3 REMOVAL OF PADS OF TELESCOPE MOVING TUBE


55 - 8
- Remove the telescopic cylinder (6TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL,
5 63).
1
- Remove the flexible guide fasteners on the moving tube (1, 055 - 8).

1 - Sling the basket/jib/hinge assembly (2, 055 - 8):


2 33 without steering actuator (3D - JIB) 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 with steering actuator (3D - JIB) 267 kg (589 lbs)

3 - Remove the axles (3, 055 - 8) then remove the basket/jib/hinge


assembly nearby to avoid damaging the hydraulic hoses and
3
wiring harnesses.

55 - 9 - Release the pads of the telescope jib by gently releasing the


moving tube (1, 055 - 9).

1 2 - Remove the pads (2, 055 - 9) of the telescope jib, pay attention to
the position and number of adjustment plates.
55

- Remove the moving tube by allowing it to slide towards the rear:


33 120 AETJL : 102 kg (225 lbs)
2 33 150 AETJC et 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ43 - AETJ43 3D:
116 kg (256 lbs)
33 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 148 kg (326 lbs)

55 - 10 - Remove the pads (1, 055 - 10), pay attention to the position and
1
number of adjustment plates.

- Get new pads (see parts catalog).

- Fit the pads and adjustment plates, then check the clearance
(655.1.1 CHECK THE CLEARANCE OF THE TELESCOPE, 5 31).
1

1
HYDRAULIC

TABLE OF CONTENTS

70.1 HYDRAULIC SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35


70.1.1 679449 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 35

70.1.2 685268 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 39

70.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43

70.2.1 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE CHASSIS - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 43

70.2.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE TURRET - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 44

70.2.3 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE JIB - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 45

70.3 HYDRAULIC CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

70.3.1 MAIN CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

70.3.2 STEERING, BASKET/TURRET ROTATION CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 47

70.3.3 BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48


PRESSURE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 48

70.3.4 TELESCOPIC CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49


PRESSURE REDUCER SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 49

70.3.5 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50


DECOMPRESSION OF THE CIRCUIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50

70
VALVE A ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 50

VALVE B ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 51

70.3.6 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PROBLEM SOLVING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52


TEST PROCEDURE . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 52

ANALYSIS OF RESULTS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 53

70.3.7 TURRET ROTATION MOTOR - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 54

70.3.8 ELECTRIC PUMP - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 55

70.3.9 REDUCING GEARS/WHEEL BRAKES - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 56

70.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 57

DISTRIBUTOR - DETAILS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 59

70.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

STEERING CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

REFIT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 60

ARM 1/2 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 61

ARM 3 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 62

TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 63

COMPENSATION/TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 64

JIB CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 66

BASKET ROTATION CYLINDER - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 67

ROTATION CYLINDER (3D - JIB) - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 68


547379EN
34 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

LINKS TO REPAIR MANUALS:

MANUAL REFERENCE
DESIGNATION
NUMBER

647 187 ROTARY ACTUATORS HELICAL HYDRAULIC L20 SERIE


70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 35

HYDRAULIC
70.1 HYDRAULIC SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS
70.1.1 679449 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM

Brakes
3D - JIB
Turret rotation rotation
25 b mini
Compensation / Tilt
210 b
Steering
P 110b Arms 1/2 EV22
Basket T
150 b rotation Arm 3 Telescope Pendular arm EV23

210 b
220 b
12
19
120 b 20 110 b Only :
210 b 210 b
25 b 25 cm3 150 AETJC 3D
M1 A8 B8 B7 A6 B6 F PF T T1 A1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A4 B4 A5 B5 E
A7 B1 AETJ43 3D
180 b
EV2
According to 16 17
18
installation 2
80b
21 150 b 80 b A

70
EV18 EV1 EV16 EV6 EV8 EV10 EV12 EV14
14 EV7 EV11 EV13 EV15
EV19 EV5 EV17 EV9
EV2b M
3
160 b

M
2b
4 5 6 13 15 7 8 9 10 11

P
100 b
See Note 1
EV3
OIL TANK

150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D


AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D
150 AETJL
170 AETJL - AETJ 49
679449 Index E
547379EN
36 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 37

This diagram relates to lifting platforms :


- 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D
- AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D
- 150 AETJL ACTIVATION TABLE FOR THE ELECTRO-VALVES
- 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 ACCORDING TO THE DESIRED MOVEMENT
COMPONANTS OF THE HYDRAULIC LAYOUT
Please refer to the hydraulic layout to match the electro-valve numbers and their location on the platform
NOTE : Delivery of the block with the adjustment 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
AETJ standard E : Excited
ev3 ev2 ev2b ev18 ev19 ev1 ev5 ev16 ev17 ev6 ev7 ev8 ev9 ev10 ev11 ev12 ev13 ev14 ev15 ev22 ev23
21 Pressure restrictor 150 b
Stop
20 Hydro accumulator 75 ml 20 b
Transport Stop + steering E E or E
19 Pressure controller 25 b Position
translation E E E
18 Balancing valve 80 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
17 Balancing valve 180 b
Stop
16 Pressure reducer 80 b
Stop + steering E E or E
15 Valve 2b
translation E E E
14 Main pressure restrictor 160 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
13 Pressure reducer
Right E E
Turret Rotation
12 Rotating JIB (Option) Left E E

70
11 Compensation / Tilt Right E E
Basket Rotation
10 Pendular arm Left E E
9 Telescope Raising E E
Raising 1-2
8 Arm 3 Work Lowering E E
Position
7 Arms 1-2 Raising E E
Raising 3
6 Basket rotation Lowering E E
5 Steering Extended E E
Telescope
4 Turret rotation Retracted E E

3 Brakes Raising E E
Pendular arm
2 Brakes Lowering E E

1 Safety valve Boost E E


Tilt
AETJ Tilt E E

No. Function Standard Right E E


Jib Rotation (option)
Taring Left E E
547379EN
38 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 39

70.1.2 685268 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM

Brakes Compensation / Tilt


3D - JIB
Turret rotation
rotation

210 b
Steering E V 22

150 b Basket 25 b mini Arm 3 Telescope Pendular arm


Arms 1/2 E V 23
rotation
21

12 220 b

110 b
180 b 210 b 210 b 210 b
25 b
E 25 cm3
M1 A8 B8 B7 A6 B6 F PF T T1 A1 B1 A2 B2 A3 B3 A4 B4 A5 B5
A7

180 b

18 19
E V2 20
2
80b
80 b A

EV 18 E V1 EV 16 E V6 E V8 E V 10 E V 12 E V 14
14 E V7

70
EV 19 E V5 E V 17 E V 2b E V9 E V 11 E V 13 E V 15

70
M

3
160 b

M
2b
4 5 6 13 15 7 8 9 10 11

P
100 b
1
See Note E V3

OIL TANK

120 AETJL
685268
Indice A
685268 Index A

Gamme AETJ - 547379


70-02-685268 FR (04/2008)
547379EN
40 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 41

This diagram relates to lifting platforms :


- 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D
- AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D
- 150 AETJL ACTIVATION TABLE FOR THE ELECTRO-VALVES
- 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 ACCORDING TO THE DESIRED MOVEMENT
COMPONANTS OF THE HYDRAULIC LAYOUT
Please refer to the hydraulic layout to match the electro-valve numbers and their location on the platform
NOTE : Delivery of the block with the adjustment 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
AETJ standard E : Excited
ev3 ev2 ev2b ev18 ev19 ev1 ev5 ev16 ev17 ev6 ev7 ev8 ev9 ev10 ev11 ev12 ev13 ev14 ev15 ev22 ev23

Stop
21 Pressure restrictor 25 b
Transport Stop + steering E E or E
20 Balancing valve 80 b Position
translation E E E
19 Balancing valve 180 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
18 Pressure restictor 80 b
Stop
16 Pressure restictor 150 b
Stop + steering E E or E
15 Shutter Valve 2b
translation E E E
14 Main pressure restrictor 160 b
translation + steering E E E E or E
13 Pressure reducer 150 b
Right E E
Turret Rotation
12 Rotating JIB (Option) Left E E

70
11 Compensation / Tilt Right E E
Basket Rotation
10 Pendular arm Left E E
9 Telescope Raising E E
Raising 1-2
8 Arm 3 Work Lowering E E
Position
7 Arms 1-2 Raising E E
Raising 3
6 Basket rotation Lowering E E
5 Steering Extended E E
Telescope
4 Turret rotation Retracted E E

3 Brakes Raising E E
Pendular arm
2 Brakes Lowering E E

1 Safety valve Boost E E


Tilt
AETJ Tilt E E

No. Function Standard Right E E


Jib Rotation (option)
Taring Left E E
547379EN
42 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 43

70.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS LOCATION

70.2.1 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE CHASSIS - LOCATION

Reducing gear/Brake
of left wheel

Steering cylinder

70
Reducing gear/Brake
of right wheel
547379EN
44 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.2.2 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE TURRET - LOCATION

Accumulator
150AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49

Oil tank

Electric pump

Backup pump
70

Turret rotation engine


Distributor block
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 45

70.2.3 HYDRAULIC COMPONENTS OF THE JIB - LOCATION


- 120 AETJL :

Compensating cylinder

Telescope cylinder

Tilting cylinder

70
Arm 3 lifting cylinder
Jib cylinder

Arm 1-2 lifting arm


cylinder

Basket rotation
cylinder
547379EN
46 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

- 150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D, 150 AETJL, 170 AETJL, AETJ43, AETJ43 3D, AETJ 49 :

Compensating
cylinder
Telescope cylinder

Tilting cylinder

3D-JIB rotation
cylinder

Arm 3 lifting cylinder

Jib cylinder
Arm 1-2 lifting
70

arm cylinder

Basket rotation cylinder


547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 47

70.3 HYDRAULIC CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT

CAUTION
In this chapter, unless specifically indicated, in order to view the setting pressure values and choose
the appropriate pressure gauge, refer to the hydraulic diagrams (670.1.1 679449 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM,
5 35))37+ (670.1.2 685268 - HYDRAULIC DIAGRAM, 5 39)41

70.3.1 MAIN CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

70 - 11
M Setting the main pressure relief valve (14, 070.1.1), (14,, 070.1.2)

1
- On the distributor, connect a pressure gauge to M (1, 070 - 11).

- Switch on the access platform.

- Control the lowering of arms 1/2 and maintain the control when
the cylinder reaches the stop.
2

- Check that the pressure gauge displays the pressure recommended


in the hydraulic diagram.

- As required, adjust the setting of the main relief valve (2, 070 - 11).

70.3.2 STEERING, BASKET/TURRET ROTATION CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

70
Setting the pressure relief valve (13, 070.1.1), (13, 070.1.2)
70 - 12
- On the distributor, connect a pressure gauge to M1 (1, 070 - 12).

- Switch on the access platform.

- Control the steering to one side and maintain the control when
the cylinder reaches the stop.

2 - Check that the pressure gauge displays the pressure recommended


in the hydraulic diagram.

M1 1
- As required, adjust the setting of the pressure reducer (2, 070 - 12)
547379EN
48 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.3 BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

CAUTION
Procedure to be performed by two people.

Use a pressure gauge with a capacity of 0 - 250 bar (0-3625.94 psi).

The pressure switch is adjusted only by TIGHTENING the adjustment screw.

70 - 13
PRESSURE SWITCH ADJUSTMENT
(17, 070.1.1),(19, 070.1.2)
2
0
- Place a Tee connector on the bypass at outlet F (1, 070 - 13) and
connect the pressure gauge (2, 070 - 13)
F .
- Switch on the access platform.
1

- Control the travel and check that the displayed pressure follows
70 - 14 P(bar)
the curve (1, 070 - 14):

1 If the pressure switch (2, 070 - 15) trips BELOW the threshold (2,
070 - 14), then, with the platform stationary, adjust the threshold
70

100>>120 bar by TIGHTENING the adjustment screw (2, 070 - 15).

- If the pressure switch (1, 070 - 15) trips ABOVE the threshold (2,
070 - 14), unscrew the adjustment screw by a few turns (2, 070 - 15),
25 bar then adjust it by TIGHTENING.
t(s)
2 Signal pressostat - Repeat the travel test.

70 - 15 NOTE: For the electrical aspects (6, 5 48)

PF
1

D-HY-278
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 49

70.3.4 TELESCOPIC CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING

70 - 16
PRESSURE REDUCER SETTING
(16, 070.1.1), (18, 070.1.2)
0 1

A3 - Decompress the telescopic line (distributor) (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR


- REMOVAL, 5 57)

2
- Place a Tee connector on the by-pass at outlet A3 (1, 070 - 16) and
connect the pressure gauge (2, 070 - 16).

- Switch on the access platform.

- Move the telescope extension and keep it moving under it reaches


its full extent.

70 - 17 - Check that the pressure gauge displays the pressure recommended


in the hydraulic diagram.

- As required, adjust the setting of the pressure reducer (1, 070 - 17).

70
547379EN
50 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.5 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING


70 - 18
DECOMPRESSION OF THE CIRCUIT
- Decompression of the compensation/
A5 0
2
tilting circuit (6COMPENSATION/TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL, 5 64)

- Switch off the power to the access platform.

VALVE A ADJUSTMENT
(17, 070.1.1), (19, 070.1.2)

- Place a Tee connector on the by-pass at outlet A5 (1, 070 - 18) and
connect the pressure gauge (2, 070 - 18).
70 - 19

- Switch on the access platform.

70 - 20
- Follow steps (1, 070 - 20), (2, 070 - 21) and (3, 070 - 22): the
verification of the setting of valve A (1 , 070 - 19) and its
70

adjustment are to be carried out during movement 3.

1
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

70 - 21 70 - 22

2
TO I T S F U L L 3
EXTENT
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 51

70 - 23

VALVE B ADJUSTMENT
2 (18,, 070.1.1), (19, 070.1.2)
B5 0

- Place a Tee connector on the by-pass at outlet B5 (1, 070 - 23) and
connect the pressure gauge (1, 070 - 23)).
1
- Switch on the access platform.

70 - 24

70 - 25
- Follow steps (1, 070 - 25) and (2, 070 - 26): the verification of
the setting of valve A (1, 070 - 24) and its adjustment are to be

70
carried out during movement 2.

1
TO I T S F U L L
EXTENT

70 - 26

2
547379EN
52 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.6 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PROBLEM SOLVING

70 - 27 - If the basket does not remain in position and drops under gravity
when the access platform is not in operation, perform the following
test procedure.
2 TEST PROCEDURE
1
- Decompression of the compensation/tilting circuit (6 70.3.11
2 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Switch off the power to the access platform.


1

- Take a drain pan and place it under the compensating cylinder.

70 - 28 - Identify the hoses connected to the compensating cylinder lower


chamber (1, 070 - 27) and remove them.
3
A5 0 - Take a straight coupler and connect the hoses from the lower
B5
chamber.
4
2
0
- Perform the same procedure for the hoses for the upper chamber
1
(2, 070 - 27).
2
1
- Remove the hoses (1, 070 - 28) connected at A5 and B5 from the
distributor block.

- Insert tee couplings between the distributor block and the hoses
70

(2, 070 - 28).


70 - 29
- Take a 0 - 200 bar (0-2900.75 psi) manometer (3, 070 - 28) and
1
connect it to the left-hand tee coupling: outlet A5.

- Take a 0 - 100 bar (0-1450.38 psi) manometer (4, 070 - 28) and
connect it to the right-hand tee coupling: outlet B5.

- Switch on the access platform.


1
- Tilt the basket and jib to their maximum extent (1, 070 - 29) several
times from the base control panel to pressurize the hydraulic circuit.

- Place the basket in the horizontal position.

- Switch off the power to the access platform.

- Note the pressure readings displayed by the two manometers.

- Check that the basket does not drop.

NOTE: This procedure may take a long time (several hours).


547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 53

ANALYSIS OF RESULTS

- THE BASKET REMAINS IN POSITION AND THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE


HAS NOT DROPPED: the cylinder or the seals of the compensating
cylinder are faulty.

- Remove the compensation cylinder


(670.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the cylinder and check the condition of the seals. Change
70 - 30 the seals if required (see parts catalog)

- Check the condition of the cylinder barrel. Replace the cylinder if


1 it has scratch marks or traces of rust or pollution (see parts catalog)
1
- THE BASKET REMAINS IN POSITION AND THE HYDRAULIC PRESSURE
HAS DROPPED IN ONE OR BOTH HYDRAULIC LINE(S): there is a
problem with the seal or the settings of one or both valves of the
distributor block.

- Decompression of the compensation/tilting circuit (6 70.3.11


CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the valve(s) (1, 070 - 30)and check the appearance of the
seals. Change the valves if the seals are defective (see parts catalog)

70
- Refit the valves then check their adjustment.............
(670.3.5 COMPENSATION/TILTING CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING, 5 50)

- THE BASKET DROPS, THE PRESSURE ON BOTH MANOMETERS


TENDS TO BALANCE (+/- 10 BAR (145.1 psi)) OR THE PRESSURE
REMAINS CONSTANT IN LINE A5 AND FALLS IN LINE B5.

- Decompression of the compensation/tilting circuit (6 70.3.11


CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the tilting cylinder (670.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL, 5 60)

- Remove the cylinder and check the condition of the seals. Change
the seals if required (see parts catalog)

- Check the condition of the cylinder barrel. Replace the cylinder if


it has scratch marks or traces of rust or pollution (see parts catalog)
547379EN
54 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.7 TURRET ROTATION MOTOR - REMOVAL

70 - 31 - Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the turret rotation line (distributor) (6 70.3.10


DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL, 5 57)

- Open the left-hand turret cover (1, 070 - 31).

70 - 32 - Remove and plug the two hoses (1, 070 - 32).

- Remove the motor attachments (2, 070 - 32).

- Remove the steering motor (3, 070 - 32)


1 1 33 36kg (80 lbs)
2

3
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 55

70.3.8 ELECTRIC PUMP - REMOVAL

70 - 33
- Open the left-hand turret cover (1, 070 - 33).

70 - 34 Following fitting (see figure, 070 - 34), (see figure, 070 - 35):

- Remove and plug the hose (1, 070 - 34), (1, 070 - 35).

- Remove and plug the connector (2, 070 - 34), (2, 070 - 35).

3 - Remove the attachments (3, 070 - 34), (3, 070 - 35) and remove the
2 4 electric pump (4, 070 - 34), (4, 070 - 35)
33 25 kg (55 lbs)
1

70
70 - 35

1
547379EN
56 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.9 REDUCING GEARS/WHEEL BRAKES - REMOVAL

70 - 36 - Raise the rear of the access platform and place blocks under the
2 frame (1, 070 - 36):

33 120 AETJL : 2680 kg (5908 lbs)


1 33 150 AETJC : 3770 kg (8311 lbs)
33 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D : 3375 kg (7440 lbs)
33 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 3842 kg (8470 lbs)
33 AETJ43 - AETJ43 3D : 3775 kg (8323 lbs)

4 - Raise arm 1/2 by 3m (118.11 in) (2, 070 - 36).


3
3
- Remove the fasteners from the rear wheels (3, 070 - 32) and remove
the wheels.
D-HY-263 33 53 kg (117 lbs)

70 - 37 - Remove the cover (4, 070 - 36).

- Mark and then remove the electric cables connected to the


motors (1, 070 - 37).

- Remove the fasteners from one of the motors (2, 070 - 37) and
3 remove this motor (B-3).
1
33 27 kg (60 lbs)
1

- Repeat the same procedure on the second engine.


70

D-HY-264

70 - 38 - Remove and plug the hoses (1, 070 - 38).

- Remove the fasteners from one of the reducing gears/brakes (2,


070 - 38) and remove this assembly (3, 070 - 38).
33 50 kg (110 lbs)
3 2
- Repeat the same procedure on the second engine.

1
REFIT
22 Wheel nut maximum tightening torque 220 N.m (1947.2 lb-in).

D-HY-265
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 57

70.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL

WARNING
The hoses connected to the compensation/tilting cylinders are under pressure EVEN WHEN STOPPED.
Before carrying out work to remove the distributor, these hoses must be decompressed by following the steps (I, 070 - 41), (II,
070 - 40) and (III, 070 - 42) because this line cannot be decompressed from the distributor.

39
70 - 41 4 70 - 40 70 - 42

3m
II (118 in) 1 cm (0.4 in)

III
3
1

TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

4
I 2

D-HY-273

70 - 43
- Open the right-hand turret cover.
4

- Remove the manual indexed control protections (1, 070 - 43).

- Decompress the hydraulic lines:

70
3
1

- Pull, push the 3 non-indexed controls (2, 070 - 43) and allow them
to return to their equilibrium position.

4 - Pull, push the 5 indexed controls (3, 070 - 43) and return them to
2 their center position.

- Replace the manual indexed control protections (1, 070 - 43).

D-HY-273
- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the distributor.

- Identify the wiring harnesses connected to the solenoids and


disconnect them.

- Remove the distributor fasteners (4 , 070 - 43) and remove the


distributor.
33 25 kg (55 lbs)

REFIT
- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit (6COMPENSATION/TILTING
CYLINDER REMOVAL, 5 64)
547379EN
58 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 59

DISTRIBUTOR - DETAILS

21

15

14
13 21

20 6
7
12 20 8
11 18
4 A - 3D-JIB power
According to 5
installation 10 Scoop supply
PF

Jib
10
3 lowering
4 M
Telescope
retracted P 20
Hydraulic Hydraulic A
Item Designation diagram diagram
Tightening torque 16 P - Electric pump
in N.m (lb-in)
679449 685268
pressure
1 Distributor - - - Arm 3 Lowered
2 Electrovalve Item 4 Item 4
Backup pump
3 Electrovalve Items 5 - 6 Items 5 - 6 39 - 51 Nm 2 Arm 1/2

70
B5
4 Electrovalve Item 3 Item 3 (345.18-451.39 lb-in) pressure
5 Electrovalve Item 2 Item 2
Lowering B4 16
B3 A5 E
6 Electrovalve
Items 7 -8 - Items 7 -8 -
44 - 56 Nm 3D-JIB Rotation
9 - 10 9 - 10 A4
(389.43-495.64 lb-in) Option B2
7 Electrovalve Item 12 Item 12 A3
B1
8 Electrovalve Item 1 Item 1
39 - 51 Nm
(345.18-451.39 lb-in)
1 LH Basket T1 A2 19 Tilting
9
Pressure reducer -
Item 13 Item 13 - rotation A1
100 bar (1450.38 psi)
10 Plug - - - B6
11
Relief valve - 150 bar
Item 21 Item 16 B7 16 Jib up
(2176.50 psi) F
A6
12
Relief valve - 160 bar LH steering M1
B8
(2321.60 psi)
Item 14 Item 14 A7
T
Relief valve - 80 bar 34 - 41 Nm A8
13
(1160.80 psi)
Item 16 Item 18
(300.93-362.88 lb-in) 18 Telescope extended
14
Counterbalance valve -
Item 17 Item 19
17 9
180 bar (2611.80 psi)
Overload valve: 80 bar
Left-hand turret Brake
15
(1160.80 psi)
Item 18 Item 20
rotation 16 Arm 3 - Lifting
25 Nm
16 Valve - -
(221.27 lb-in)
Check valve - Right-hand turret
17 2 bar Item 15 Item 15 - rotation Return to tank Arm 1/2 - Lifting
(29.02 psi)
18 Valve - - -
19 Electrovalve - -
Pressure switch - 25b
20 Nm RH steering RH Basket rotation
20 Item 19 Item 21 (177.01 lb-in)
(362.75 psi)
21 Protector - - -
547379EN
60 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

70.3.11 CYLINDERS - REMOVAL


STEERING CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 44 - Raise the front (1, 070 - 44) of the access platform and place blocks
under the frame:

33 - 120 AETJL : 2400 kg (5291 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC : 3000 kg (6614 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D : 2550 kg (5622 lbs)
3 33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ49 : 3100 kg (6834 lbs)
2 33 - AETJ 43 - AETJ43 3D : 3775 kg (8322 lbs)

- Remove the front cover (2, 070 - 44).


1

- Open the right-hand turret cover (3, 070 - 44).

- Decompress the steering line (distributor) (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR


- REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 45 - Remove and plug the hoses connected to the steering cylinder


(1, 070 - 45).
2

- Remove the pivot pins from the steering cylinder (2, 070 - 45) and
remove the cylinder.
2
70

REFIT
1

- Carry out the removal operations in reverse order, leaving the


access platform on supports.

- Drain the steering circuit:

- Control the steering until it reaches its mechanical stop on both


sides, simultaneously repeating the operation several times.

- Remove the supports from under the front axle and carry out
steering tests while stationary, and then when moving.
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 61

ARM 1/2 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 46 - Raise arm 1/2 so that the intermediate hinge (1, 070 - 46) is raised
1m (39.37 in).

- Switch off the power supply.


2

- Secure the intermediate hinge with a hoist and a sling (2, 070 - 46):

1 33 - 120 AETJL: 1100 kg (2425 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - AETJ43 - AETJ 43 3D : 1600 kg (3527 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 1700 kg (3748 lbs)

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the arm 1/2 lifting line (distributor) (6 70.3.10


DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 47 - Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 47).

2
- Remove the pivot pins from the cylinder, starting with the cylinder
head pin (2, 070 - 47) and remove the cylinder:
33 - 120 AETJL : 25 kg (55 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - AETJ43 -
AETJ 43 3D - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 70 kg (154 lbs)
1
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder

70
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)

REFIT

- Carry out the removal operations in reverse order, leaving the


intermediate hinge supported by a strap.

- Slowly lower the intermediate hinge until the arms find their
equilibrium position.

- Remove the strap.

- Lower arms 1/2 to the transport position.

- Raise arms 1/2 to their maximum extent and repeat these operations
several times.
547379EN
62 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

ARM 3 LIFTING CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 48 - Raise the arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 070 - 48) is raised by
1m (39.37 in).

- Switch off the power supply.


1

1
- Secure the basket and arm 3 with a hoist (2, 070 - 48) and a sling
(stabilize with a support):

33 - 120 AETJL : 580 kg (1279 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D:
650 kg (1433 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 : 900 kg (1984 lbs)

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the lifting line of arm 3 (distributor) (6 70.3.10


DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 49 - Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 49).

- Remove the pivot pins from the cylinder, starting with the cylinder
foot pivot pin (2, 070 - 49) and remove the cylinder:
1

33 - 120 AETJL : 30 kg (66 lbs)


70

2
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - AETJ43 -
AETJ 43 3D - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 50 kg (111 lbs)

NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder


(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)

REFIT

- Lower arm 3 to the transport position.

- Raise arm 3 to its maximum extent and repeat these operations


several times
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 63

TELESCOPIC CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 50 - Raise arm 3 to the horizontal position (1, 070 - 50).

- Move the telescope extension (2, 070 - 50) by 1 m (39.37 in).


1 2

3
- Remove the cylinder head pivot pin (3, 070 - 50).

- Retract the telescope.

- Switch off the power supply.

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the telescopic line (distributor) (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR


- REMOVAL, 5 57)

70 - 51 - Remove the telescope base cover (1, 070 - 51).

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (2, 070 - 51).

2
1
- Remove the cylinder foot pivot pin (3, 070 - 51) and remove the
3
2
telescope cylinder:
33 - 120 AETJL : 34 kg (75 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D : 39 kg (86 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL : 42 kg (93 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49 : 55 kg (121 lbs)

70
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)
547379EN
64 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

COMPENSATION/TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL


WARNING
The hose connected to the compensation/tilting cylinders are pressurized EVEN WHEN STOPPED.
Before carrying out work to remove the cylinders, these hoses must be decompressed by following
the steps (I, 070 - 53), (II, 070 - 52) and (III, 070 - 54) because this line cannot be decompressed from the
distributor.

70 - 53 70 - 52 70 - 54

3m
(118.11in)
II 1 cm (0.39 in)

III

TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

70 - 55

Compensating cylinder

1 - Raise arm 1/2 so that the intermediate hinge (1, 070 - 55) is raised
1m (39.37 in).
70

- Switch off the power supply.

- Secure the basket/jib assembly with a hoist and a sling:


33 without rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 with rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 267 kg (589 lbs)

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Remove the cylinder pivot pins (1, 070 - 56) and remove the cylinder
70 - 56
from the arms while leaving it connected to the hoses:
33 - 120 AETJL : 18 kg (40 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL : 20 kg (44 lbs)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder and remove
1
the cylinder.
NOTE: This cylinder has no valves.

REFIT

- Follow the removal operations in reverse order.


- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit by repeating steps I to
VII several times (I & II, 070 - 59), (III & IV, 070 - 62), (V & VI, 070 - 61),
(VII, 070 - 60).
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 65

70 - 57
2
Tilting cylinder

- Move the telescope extension by 1m (1, 070 - 57).


- Switch off the power supply.
1 - Secure the basket/jib assembly with a hoist and a sling (2, 070 - 57):
1 m (39.37 in) 33 without rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 with rotation cylinder (3D - JIB): 267 kg (589 lbs)
- Place the assembly on a stable surface.

- Remove the cylinder pivot pins (2, 070 - 58) and remove the cylinder
from the arms while leaving it connected to the hoses.
70 - 58
33 - 22 kg (49 lbs)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 58)
2 2 and remove the cylinder.

1
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)

REFIT
- Follow the removal operations in reverse order.
- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit by repeating steps I to
VII several times (I & II, 070 - 59), (III & IV, 070 - 62), (V & VI, 070 - 61),
(VII, 070 - 60).
.
70 - 59 70 - 62 TO ITS FULL
TO ITS FULL EXTENT

70
EXTENT

IV

II III
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

70 - 61 70 - 60

TO ITS FULL
EXTENT
VII

V
TO ITS FULL
EXTENT

VI
547379EN
66 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

JIB CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 63 - Lift the jib (1, 070 - 63) to the horizontal position.


2
- Switch off the power supply.

- Secure the basket with a hoist and a sling (2, 070 - 63)
33 - 170 kg (375 lbs)

- Place the assembly on a stable surface.


1

70 - 64 - Open the right-hand turret cover.

- Decompress the jib lifting line (670.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR - REMOVAL,


5 57)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 64).
2
1
- Remove the pivot pins from the cylinder, starting with the cylinder
foot pivot pin (2, 070 - 64) and remove the cylinder:
33 - 15 kg (33 lbs)
70

NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder


(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 67

BASKET ROTATION CYLINDER - REMOVAL

70 - 65 - Lift the jib (1, 070 - 65) to the horizontal position.

- Switch off the power supply.

- Open the right-hand turret cover.


70 - 66

- Decompress the basket rotation line (6 70.3.10 DISTRIBUTOR -


REMOVAL, 5 57)

- Remove and plug the hoses connected to the cylinder (1, 070 - 49).
1
3
2 - Remove the cylinder foot pivot pin (2, 070 - 66) and the nut of the
cylinder head pin (3, 070 - 66) and remove the cylinder.

70
NOTE: Before attempting to disassemble the removed cylinder
(6VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL, 5 69)
547379EN
68 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)

ROTATION CYLINDER (3D - JIB) - REMOVAL

70 - 67 - Decompression of the tilting cylinder circuit (6COMPENSATION/


TILTING CYLINDER REMOVAL, 5 64).

- Move the telescope extension by 1 m (39.37 in)

- Switch off the power supply.

- Open the right-hand turret cover.

1 m (39.37 in) - Decompress:


⇒⇒ the jib lifting line
⇒⇒ the 3D rotation cylinder line.

- Secure the basket/jib assembly with a hoist and a sling (see


figure, 070 - 67).
33 - 267 kg (589 lbs).

70 - 68 - Remove and plug the hoses from the 3D rotation cylinder (2, 070 - 68).

- Remove the basket/jib assembly (1, 070 - 67), if necessary remove


the harnesses and the hoses of the jib cylinder (6JIB CYLINDER -
4
REMOVAL, 5 66).

2
- Remove the 3D rotation cylinder pivot pin (1, 070 - 68).
70

- Secure the 3D rotation cylinder assembly with a hoist and a sling


70 - 69 (see figure, 070 - 69).
33 - 37 kg (82 lbs)

- Démonter l’axe d’articulation du vérin d’inclinaison (3, 070 - 68),


et l’axe d’articulation du bras (4, 070 - 68).

Remove the 3D rotation cylinder.

REFIT
- Follow the removal operations in reverse order.

- Purge the compensation/tilting circuit by repeating steps I to


VII several times (I & II, 070 - 59), (III & IV, 070 - 62), (V & VI, 070 - 61),
(VII, 070 - 60).

- Purge the 3D rotation cylinder, if it rebounds excessively after


being connected. Perform at least 5 rotations to its maximum extent.
547379EN
70 (08/03/2017) HYDRAULIC 69

VALVE BLOCKS AND VALVES - REMOVAL

WARNING
A cylinder fitted with valves may have chambers with VERY HIGH PRESSURES, higher than 100 bars (1450.38 psi) (tilting cylinder
or cylinder with rod fully retracted or extended) even after being removed. The pressures in the chambers should be released
before disassembly.

CAUTION
Ideally, this procedure should only be carried out on cylinders whose ROD is at MID-STROKE.
In order to work under optimum safety conditions, the operator must wear protective goggles, rubber gloves, and carry a rubber
sheet

Removal of a fitted valve block

WARNING
In order to avoid pressurized oil leaks, the operator should position the cylinder with the contact face (1, 070 - 70) between the
valve block and the cylinder, vertically, and then position a rubber sheet over this face (2, 070 - 70).

70 - 70 - Secure the cylinder body in a vise.


HAUT
- Loosen the fixing screws of the block (3, 070 - 70) one after another,
by a MAXIMUM of 1/4 turn for each screw.
2

1 BAS - Unscrew the screws by 1/4 turn WITH A SPANNER until the
pressure has been released.

70
3 3

Removal of a valve
3
3
- Secure the cylinder body in a vice

WARNING
In order to avoid pressurized oil leaks, the operator should position a rubber sheet (1, 070 - 71) over the valve seat after positioning
its wrench

70 - 71 Loosen the valves (2, 070 - 71) in turn: MAXIMUM 1/4 of a turn per
valve.

1 - Unscrew the valves by 1/4 turn WITH A SPANNER until the


pressure has been released.

2
547379EN
70 HYDRAULIC 70 (08/03/2017)
70
ELECTRICITY

TABLE OF CONTENTS

80.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 73

80.1.1 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 75

80.1.2 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASE CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 76

80.1.3 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 77

80.1.4 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 78

80.1.5 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 79

80.1.6 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 80

80.1.7 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 81


80.1.8 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 82

80.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

80.2.1 ELECTRICAL CONTROL COMPONENTS - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 83

80.2.2 ELECTRICAL POWER COMPONENTS - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 84

80.4.4 WIRING BASED ON SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM 676423 - 1ST VERSION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85

LOCATION OF WIRING HARNESSES ON THE ACCESS PLATFORM . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 85

BASKET CONTROL PANEL HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 86

OVERLOAD SENSORS HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 89

UPPER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 90

LOWER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 92

UPPER BUS-CAN CONTROL PANEL OUTPUT HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 93

BASE BOX HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 94

80
VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 96

ELECTROVALVE HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 97

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 98

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 99

80.3 ELECTRICAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101

80.3.1 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 101

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102

EXTERNAL VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102

INTERNAL VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 102

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 103

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 104

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATORS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 105


547379EN
72 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.3.2 IES BATTERY CHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106

IES BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 106

IES BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

EXTERNAL VIEW . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 107

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

IES BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 108

80.3.3 ELECTRONIC MODULES - CONTROL AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 109

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS DESCRIPTION AND WIRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 110

ELECTRONIC MODULES - DIAGNOSTICS AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 114

80.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 115

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - WIRING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 116

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DIAGNOSTIC AND ADJUSTMENT TOOLS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 118

BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR/HOUR METER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 119

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 120

80.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

SWITCHES - LOCATION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

TILT SENSOR - SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 126

ARM DOWN SENSORS - SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 127

BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - CHECKING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 128

OVERLOAD SENSORS - SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 129

MULTIMETER TEST . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 132

80.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133

MANIPULATOR - TESTS USING CALIBRATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 133


80

MANIPULATOR - TEST WITH A VOLTMETER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 134

80.4 ELECTRICITY REMOVALS - REFITTING . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136

80.4.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 136

80.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 137

80.4.3 ELECTRICAL HARNESSES - REMOVAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 138

80.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139

80.5.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - FAULTS AND FIXES . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 139

80.5.2 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - ERROR SIGNALS . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143

80.5.3 IES BATTERY CHARGER . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 143

80.6 SPECIFIC TOOLING - ELECTRICITY . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

80.6.1 CALIBRATOR . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144

DESCRIPTION . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . . 144
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 73

ELECTRICITY

80.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS

WARNING
Diagram 1 VERSIONst

Access platform fitted with an overload sensor harness comprising:


a Deutsch connector with........................................................... 8-way

SQ5a SQ5a

SQ5b

WARNING
Diagram 2 VERSIONnd

Access platform fitted with an overload sensor harness comprising:


a Deutsch connector with........................................................... 3-way

80
SQ5a

SQ5b SQ5b
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 75

80.1.1 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators hyave a nominal voltage of 24 V *

B
CHARGER
(network)

yellow
white

black singles Base control


blue Platform control
green Emergency
stop
Nr. 2 BASKET
C /BASE
RED GREEN
selector

black TILT/SLOPE
red

D
ELECTRIC-PUMP 678423 - Index R
Page 1/4
325

arm low A

VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (power) VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (logic) supply


E pressure stat
tel. retracted A

Base select.
tilt
line
trac./pump

Left Right
TRACTION MOTORS

telescope
arm low

80
retracted

te tra a)
pressure stat. pump

to
TRACTION/

le ct

ar
LINE

re (
sc ed

m
el
(brakes

op
PUMP

ec 48V
CONTACTOR

lo
tro

w
e
BATTERY POWER Emergency SWITCHING released)

(a
-v

)
CHARGE

alv
ON stop 2

s e
H

J
547379EN
76 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.2 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASE CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators have a nominal voltage of 24V *

C
CAN bus socket : Diagnostics
Connection to the calibrator
MOLEX Mini-Fit box 678423 - Index R
for male / 6 way contacts
Page 2/4
Pendular arm

rotation
arm
Pendular

JIB rotation Right


Turret
rotation

JIB rotation Left


pendular arm/Down Send to tank
pendular arm/Up Klaxon
telescope/Retracted Flashing light
telescope/Extended
D turret rot. Right
JIB rot. L
JIB rot. R
turret rot. Left Turret rot. Left
Basket rot. Left
compensation R
pendular arm R
telescope Extended
arm 3 R
arms 1,2 R
Tilt
Basket
rotation

Arms
Arm

compensation / Down turret rot. R


compensation / Up steering R
arm 3 / Down basket rot. R
arm 3 / Up compensation Up
arm 1/2 / Down
E arm 1/2 / Up brake
basket rot. Right steer L
basket rot. Left pump
pendular arm Up
telescope extended
arm 3 Up
arms 1.2 Up
CONTROL CONSOLE

Timer
80

white/brown
white/blue
blue
G brown

ARMS ARM PENDULAR ARM TILT BASKET PENDULAR ARM S


M St Br Br St TURRET Se upp Fla
O ee ak ak ee Ho
wa ver wa ain rL e e rR S nd ly shi rn
rn loa rn ten ef
t ig ele upp Do Do Ex Re Up
Do to ng
in d in an ht ct ly t Up Up wn te tra wn Do Ri Le Ri Le tan lig
g g c ro o wn n ct Up wn gh f gh ht
e -v sio io t f t Ri Le k
alv t t gh f
H es
n n
t
t

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 77

80.1.3 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators have a nominal voltage of 24V *

C Overload arms 1/2 arm 3 - Basket pendular arm


- Turret
horn

678423 - Index R
Page 3/4
Emergency stop
horn
D pendular arm selection
power telescope selection
supply compensation selection
power JIB rotation
supply turret rotation
basket rotation
Arm 3 selection
Arms 1/2 selection
translation selection
SQ5a Overload Overload warning
SQ5b Overload overload
maintenance warning Maintenance warning
Overload buzzer
E pendular arm
telescope
compensation
JIB rotation
turret rotation
basket rotation
instruction rotation arm 3
steer left arms 1/2
steer right translation
traction instruction tilt
Dead man’s system alarm/faults
Except for NEUTRAL Ref. Overload
Ref. tilt
F

green
yellow
blue
black

80
grey (Y)
violet
red
pink
G brown
white

Overload Tilt ARMS ARM BASKET TURRET PENDULAR


24V 2-AXIS joystick warning ROTATION ARM
H (red)
(All the LEDs are supplied with 24V)

J
547379EN
78 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.4 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 1ST VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

* Unless otherwise stated, the indicator lights and actuators have a nominal voltage of 24V *
B

Sector sensor control module

D 678423 - Index R
Page 4/4
arm low B
arm low A
telescope retracted A
telescope retracted B
overload SQ5a
E overload SQ5b
speed reduction return
overload validation return

speed return
overload validation

F
(+ dedicated soft)
80

H
ar w

re
lo
m

tra
tec

I
d

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 79

80.1.5 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - POWER PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

CHARGER
C
(network)

yellow supply
white

black (singles LEDS) B: Base control 678423 - Index S


blue
green
Base
P: Platform control Page 1/4
Emergency
Stop
BASE/
RED GREEN BASKET
Selector

D
black SLOPE
red

ELECTRIC- PUMP
3,6 KW/48V

+10V5 : A1
E 0V : A2
n. c. : A3
+10V5 : A4
CAN-H : A5
CAN-L : A6
VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (logic)

arm low A : B3
supply : B1
VARIABLE SPEED DRIVE (power) pressure stat : B2
tel_retracted_A : B06
Base selector : B5
slope : B4
: B7
F line : B8
trac./pump : B9
+12v : B12

80
Left Right
TRACTION MOTORS
G SEM XP1747,48V
retracted arm low

Eleupp
s

ar
ct ly

m
ro
LINE pump

-v

lo
TRACTION/PUMP pressure stat

alv

w
CONTACTOR (brakes released)
SWITCHING

es
BATTERY EMERGENCY

re
POWER ON

t
CHARGE STOP 2

ra
ct
ed
H

J
547379EN
80 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.6 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

CAN-L : CAN-6 CAN bus socket : Diagnostics


CAN-H : CAN-5
+12V : CAN-4 MOLEX Mini-Fit box B: Base control
P: Platform control
678423 - Index S
0V : CAN-2 for males/ 6 way contacts
Page 2/4
arm rot.
Pendular

+12V : CAN-1
arm
Pendular
rotation
Turret

B+
Di 01 : JIB rot. R B+2
Di 16 : JIB rot. L
Di 13 : pendular arm/Down send to tank : Do 01
Di 12 : pendular arm/Up horn : Do 19
flashing light : Do 20
D Di 08 : telescope/Retracted
Di 09 : telescope/Extended rot. JIB L : Do 11
Di 07 : Right turret rot. rot. JIB R : Do 17
Di 06 : Left turret rot. turret rot. L : Do 08
basket rot. : Do 12
compensation R : Do 14
pendular arm R : Do 06
telescope R : Do 09
arm 3 R : Do 04
arms 1,2 R : Do 02
arm
Lower

arm
Upper
rotation
Basket

Tilt

Di 11 : compensation/down turret rot. R : Do 10


Di 10 : compensation/down Steer R : Do 16
Di 05 : upper arm 3 /Down basket rot. R : Do 18
Di 04 : upper arm 3 /Up compensation Up : Do 21
Di 03 : lower arm 1,2 /Down
E Di 02 : lower arm 1,2 /Up brake : Do 22
Di 15 : Right basket rot. steer L : Do 15
Di 14 : Left basket rot. pump : Do 24
pendular arm Up : Do 07
telescope Extended : Do 13
arm 3 Up : Do 05
arms 1,2 Up : Do 03
C-NEG
D-NEG
B-NEG

Timer
80

TILT
Br

ARMS ARM PENDULAR ARM BASKET PENDULAR ARM


Br

TURRET
St

Fla
ak

Ho
St
Ov ar

M w

ak

ROTATION ROTATION

Se
El
Su ctro
ee

ROTATION
ee
e
ain ar

sh
e
e

rn
w
er nin

nd
rL

pp -v

(JIB)
rR

Su o ta

i
lo g

ng
te nin

Re

Do
ef

Do
ly alv

Do

Ex

t
Le
ad

pp nk
ig

Do
Up

Up
na g

Up

Ri
t

tra

Le
Up

Ri

lig
to es

te

w
w
ht

f
gh

ly
nc

t
w

Le
gh

f
n
n

ct

ht
n

Ri
t
n
sio

t
e

f
io

gh

t
n
n

t
H

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 81

80.1.7 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

C
1 - basket
Overload arms 1.2 arm 3 2 - turret compensation pendular arm
selection selection 3 - JIB selection selection horn
678423 - Index S
Page 3/4
CAN6 : CAN-L
Basket CAN5 : CAN-H
Emergency stop
D Di 16 : horn
Di 12 : pendular arm selection
Di 11 : telescope selection
Di 13 : compensation selection
Di 08 : JIB rot.
Di 15 : turret rot. B+
Di 14 : basket rot. B+2
Di 10 : arm 3 selection B/NEG
Di 09 : arms 1,2 selection C/NEG
Di 03 : translation selection D/NEG
Di 05 : SQ5b overload
overload : Do 21 Overload warning
Di 02 : (available) Maintenance warning
maintenance warning : Do 19
Overload buzzer : Do 15
E pendular arm : Do 05
telescope : Do 04
compensation : Do 07
JIB rot. : Do 06
turret rot. : Do 01
basket rot. : Do 08
Ai 01 : rotation instruction arm 3 : Do 03
Di 06 : steer Left arms 1,2 : Do 02
Di 07 : steer Right translation : Do 13
Ai 02 : traction instruction slope : Do 16
Di 01 : Dead man's system alarme/faults : Do 14
Di 04 : Except for NEUTRAL Ref. overload : Do 18
(spare) : Do 22

green
yellow
yellow/black
grey/black
grey (Y)
green/black

80
brown/black
white/black
brown
white
G

Overload Slope ARMS 1.2 ARM 3 BASKET TURRET JIB PENDULAR ARM
24V 2-AXIS JOYSTICK warning (red) ROTATION ROTATION ROTATION

(all the LEDs are supplied with 24V)

J
547379EN
82 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.1.8 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - SAFETY CONTROL UNIT PART - 2ND VERSION


1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14

Sector sensor control module


678423 - Index S
C
Page 4/4

A5 : CAN-L
A6 : CAN-H

D
B02 : arm low B
B01 : arm low A
B03 : telescope retracted A
B04 : telescope retracted B
B05: overload SQ5b
B06 : overload SQ5a
B07 : speed reduction return
BO8 : overload validation return
E

Out_2 :
Out_1 : Overload Validation

( + dedicated soft)

F
80

H
lo te
w lesc
ar op
m
(b er
) et
ra
c te
d

J
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 83

80.2 ELECTRICAL COMPONENTS LOCATION

80.2.1 ELECTRICAL CONTROL COMPONENTS - LOCATION


Rotating
Retracted telescope beacon light Tilt sensor
sensor

Horn Base control panel

Safety control card


Arm down sensors
150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49

Base module control unit

Basket module control unit

80
Basket control panel

LED showing charging states Battery charge indicator/


Low arm sensors 120 AETJL
removed hour meter

Overload sensors
547379EN
84 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.2.2 ELECTRICAL POWER COMPONENTS - LOCATION

Electric pump

Left-hand battery

Variable speed controller Safety control card


plate

Left traction motor Right-hand battery


80

Battery cut-off

Variable speed controller


plate relay

IES charger
Right traction motor
ZIVAN charger
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 85

80.4.4 WIRING BASED ON SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM 676423 - 1ST VERSION

LOCATION OF WIRING HARNESSES ON THE ACCESS PLATFORM 13

13 3 12
3 4 5 2

1 2
10

15
9
15

11 8
12
14

16

120 AETJL

Item Designation
1 Basket control panel
2 Upper CAN extension harness
3 Lower CAN extension harness
4 BUS-CAN harness output
5 Base box
6 Variable speed controller harness
7 Electrovalve harness
8 Tilt wiring harness
9 Horn harness
10 Flashing flight harness
11 Output sensor control panel harness
12 - Intermediate inductive sensors harness
(150 AETJC - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49)
- Telescopic arm sensors harness (120 AETJL)
13 Telescope arm sensor
14 Low arm sensor harness

80
15 Arm down sensor
13
16 Overload sensors
15 15 3 4 14 5 2 13 3 12

10

1 2

11 8
12

16
6
7

150 AETJL
150 AETJLC
150 AETJC 3D
150 AETJL
170 AETJL
AETJ 43
AETJ 43 3D
547379EN
86 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

BASKET CONTROL PANEL HARNESS


- ITEM 1
Installation procedure:
- 678383 - C (120 AETJL, 150 AETJC,150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL,170 AETJL).

S13 S15 S19 S20 S18 S22

H18 137 135


H7
1 1
311
305
H10 H15
330 331
303 2 2
A5 H16 H14
327 304
309
322
321 323 106 106 123 123
106
H9
328 307
308 S17
S21
302
H8
103
310
S14 306
329 103
103

106

HD 30

8S 320
1 2
8 7

8P PC
3 4
6 5

8P H17
314

CIRC IMP

313 103

To overload To overload
BASKET CONSOLE sensors harness sensors harness
HARNESS Ref. 16 Ref. 16
Ref. 1
80

HD 30a

8S 8P 8P PC 15
16 14
17 5 4 13
Ref. Designation Ref. Designation
18 1
1 2 3 4 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 6 3
12
8 7 6 5 5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8 19 11 A4 Basket module card S13 Translation selector
20
7 2 10 A5 Manipulator S14 Arm 1/2 up / down selector
8 9 PRINT.CIRC Printed circuit S15 Arm 3 up / down selector
H7 Tilt LED S17 Pendular arm / turret / basket rotation selector
Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire H8 Translation LED S18 Tilt / reverse tilt selector
1 green 1 314 1 332 1 112 H9 Arm 1/2 up LED S19 Telescope extension / retraction selector
2 yellow 2 315 2 335 2 113
3 yellow/black H10 Arm 3 up LED S20 Pendular arm up / down selector
3 316 3 312 3 spare
4 grey/black 4 317 4 335 4 135 H14 Tilt / reverse tilt LED S21 Horn button
5 white 5 123 5 333 5 137 H15 Telescope LED
6 white/black S22 Emergency Stop
6 103 6 335 6 spare H16 Pendular arm up LED
brown/black 7 319 7 spare 7 332 8S 8-port male Deutsch connector
brown 8 318 8 spare 8 333 H17 Buzzer
7 green/black 8P 8-port female Deutsch connector
9 338 H18 Overload LED 8P PC 8-port female Deutsch through-partition connector
8 grey 10 103
11 106 HD30 20-port female Deutsch through-partition connector
12 123
13 336
14 337
15 319
16 400 Optional spare
17 401 Optional spare
18 402 Optional spare
19 spare
20 spare
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 87

- ITEM 1
Installation procedure:
- 52501871. (150 AETJC,150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL,170 AETJL)
- 52556918. (AETJ 43,AETJ 43 3D, AETJ 49)

S14 S15 S19 S20 S18 S22

H18 137 135


H7 103
1 1
310
305
H10 H15
330 331
2 2
A5 H16 303 H14
327 304
309
322
321 323 106 123 4S
106
H9 106 12P7 123 4S

328 307
308 S17
S21
302
H8
103
311
S13 306
329 103
103

103 8P 6

106

12P PC
4P PC

320
12 11 10 9
1 2 3 4
1 2
8 7

4
1

8P PC
3 4
6 5

3
2

5 6
8 7

H17
314
6S
4S
CIRC IMP

313 103

To overload To upper BUS CAN


BASKET sensors harness extension harness

80
CONSOLE HARNESS
Ref. 16 Rep. 2
Ref. 1

Ref. Designation Ref. Designation


6S 4S 8P PC 4P 12P A4 Basket module card S13 Translation selector
A5 Manipulator S14 Arm 1/2 up / down selector
4 3
PRINT.CIRC Printed circuit S15 Arm 3 up / down selector
4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7
5 6 7 8 1 2 3 4 5 6 H7 Tilt LED S17 Pendular arm / turret / basket rotation selector
1 2
H8 Translation LED S18 Tilt / reverse tilt selector
H9 Arm 1/2 up LED S19 Telescope extension / retraction selector
Pos Wire Pos Wire Pos Wire Pos Wire Pos Wire
1 318 1 123 1 332 1 338 1 112 H10 Arm 3 up LED S20 Pendular arm up / down selector
2 315 2 103 2 335 2 400 2 113 H14 Tilt / reverse tilt LED S21 Horn button
3 316 3 103 3 312 3 401 3 135 H15 Telescope LED S22 Emergency Stop
4 317 4 103 4 335 4 402 4 137 H16 Pendular arm up LED
5 314 5 333 4S 4-port male Deutsch connector
5 333
6 319 6 335 H17 Buzzer 6S 6-port male Deutsch connector
6 103
7 libre 7 106 H18 Overload LED 8P PC 8-port female Deutsch through-partition connector
8 libre 8 123 4P PC 4-port female
9 336 Deutsch through-partition connector
10 337 12P PC 12-port female
11 319 Deutsch through-partition connector
12 332
547379EN
88 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Basket module control unit

D-IN D-OUT D-NEG A-IN CAN


C-NEG
A4 B+2 B+ B-NEG

106 103

103 103

103 according to installation

16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 8 7 6 5 6 5 4
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


Pos. Wire
1 spare 1 315 1 spare
1 319
2 328 2 318 2 spare
2 312
3 327 3 spare 3 spare
3 311
4 322 4 spare 4 spare
4 313
5 321 5 spare 5 113
5 332
6 spare 6 spare 6 112
6 316
7 323 7 spare
7 317
8 spare 8 spare
80

8 306
9 spare
9 310
10 spare
10 309
11 spare
11 304
12 spare
12 303
13 305 13 329
14 308 14 331
15 307 15 320
16 302 16 330
17 spare
18 335
19 337
20 spare
21 336
22 338
23 spare
24 spare
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 89

OVERLOAD SENSORS HARNESS


- ITEM 16

To full basket control


panel
Item 1

5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1

Pin Wire Color


1 332 black
2 335 black/white
3 312 brown
OVERLOAD SENSORS
4 335 blue
HARNESS 5 333 black

80
678849 - D 6 335 black/white
Item 16 7 - free
8 - free

SQ5a SQ5b
547379EN
90 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

UPPER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS


- ITEM 2
Installation procedure:
678855 - C (120 AETJL)
678387 - D (150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL)
678643 - E (170 AETJL)

15
14 16
To complete 17
basket console 13 4 5
12 1 18
Ref. 1 3 6
11 19
2 7 20
10
9 8

Pos. Wire
1 112
2 113
3 Spare
4 135
5 137
6 Spare
7 332
8 333
9 338
10 103
11 106
12 123
13 336
14 337
15 319
16 400 optional spare
17 401 optional spare
18 402 optional spare
19 Spare

UPPER BUS CAN 20 Spare

EXTENSION HARNESS
Ref. 2
80

1
8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 112
2 113
3 135
4
5
137
332
2
6 333
7 402 8 7 6 5
8 338 1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 103
2 106
3 123
4 336
5 337
6 319
7 400
8 401
To lower CAN BUS
extension bundle
Ref. 3
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 91

Installation procedure:
52501939.(150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D,150 AETJL, AETJ 43, AETJ 43 3D)
52501918. (170 AETJL, AETJ 49)

To complete
basket console
Ref. 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 338 1 112
2 400 2 113
3 401 3 135
4 402 4 137
5 333
6 103
7 106
8 123
9 336
10 337
11 319
12 332

UPPER BUS CAN


EXTENSION HARNESS
52501939 (150 AETJC - 150 AETC 3D - 150 AETJL - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D)
52501918. (170 AETJL - AETJ 49)
Ref. 2

1 80
8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 112
2 113
3 135
4
5
6
137
332
333
2
7 402
8 338 8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire
1 103
2 106
3 123
4 336
5 337
6 319
To lower BUS CAN 7 400
extension harness 8 401
Ref. 3
547379EN
92 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

LOWER BUS-CAN EXTENSION HARNESS


- ITEM 3 To upper BUS CAN
extension harness
as mounting
Ref. 2

5 6 7 8 5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1 4 3 2 1

1
Pos. Wire Pos. Wire
1 112 1 103
2 113 2 106
3 135 3 123
4 137 4 336
5 332 5 337

2
6 333 6 319
7 402 7 400
8 338 8 401

LOWER BUS CAN


EXTENSION BUNDLE
678863 - B (120 AETJL)
678388 - D (150 AETJ COMPACT - 150 AETJC 3D
150 AETJL - 170 AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49)
Ref. 3
80

1 2
8 7 6 5 8 7 6 5
1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 112 1 103
2 113 2 106
3 135 3 123
4 137 4 336
5 332 5 337
6 333 6 319
7 402 7 400
8 338 8 401

To BUS CAN console


output bundle
Ref. 4
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 93

UPPER BUS-CAN CONTROL PANEL OUTPUT HARNESS


- ITEM 4 To lower BUS CAN
extension harness
Ref. 3

5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1 5 6 7 8
4 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 112 1 103
2 113 2 106
3 135 3 123
4
5
6
137
332
333
1 2 4
5
6
336
337
319
7 402 7 400
8 338 8 401

BUS CAN CONSOLE


OUTPUT HARNESS
678394 - C
Ref. 4

80
402 401 400 319 338 333 332 137 135 113 123 112 103 106 337 336

To complete base box


Rep. 5
547379EN
94 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

BASE BOX HARNESS


- ITEM 5 A3 A6

241 407 106


103 103

107 242
242 408

KA1
KA10
KA11

319 106
263 405 406
106 106

OUTPUT

338 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 112 112 113 243 TERMINAL
119 109 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 106 112 113 113 243

INPUT

338 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 112 112 113 243
119 109 241 241 241 241 241 123 123 103 103 103 106 106 106 106 106 112 113 113 243

104
137

BUS CAN console ensor console


output harness output harness
F3 + 24V F2 + 24V Ref. 4 Ref. 11

Variable speed Flashing light


drive harness Electro-valve Tilt Alarm harness
Ref. 6 harness
100 101 harness harness Ref. 10
Ref. 7
Ref. 8 Ref. 9

D-IN D-OUT D-NEG A-IN CAN


C-NEG
A3 B+2 B+ B-NEG
80

106 103

4 5 6
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 6 5 4
1 2 3
8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 215 1 262 1 jaune J1-1 1 jaune J1-1
2 214 2 227 2 jaune J1-2 2 jaune J1-2
3 213 3 239 3 127 3 127
4 212 4 226 4 243 4 243
5 211 5 238 5 113 5 113
6 208 6 224 6 112 6 112
7 207 7 236
8 205 8 221
9 206 9 225
10 201 10 228
11 202 11 219
12 209 12 222
13 210 13 237
14 204 14 223 BASE BOX
15 203 15 234 HARNESS
16 216 16 229
17 220 679459 - G (120 AETJL
18 230 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL
19 217 52556928. (AET 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49)
20 218
21 231 Ref. 5
22 233
23 spare
24 235
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 95

216 263 204 263


263 215 263 203

S8
206 263
S11 263 205
S7
S9

211 S6 210
263 263 115 337
263 263 114 336
yellow yellow
212
209
116 106 yellow
S10 263
H1 H2 H3 H4
6 5 4 263
3 2 1
213 108 108
263 S23
110
263
108 105
214
P2
1 1
S5 202
S2
3 3 3 3 3 S3 2 2
4 4 4 4 4
263
208 263
201
263 207

S12
103 135 104 137 F3
106 123
137 CAN BUS

B+ OUT2 B
A6 B- OUT1 CAN SECU

6 5 4
3 2 1

106 405
Pos. Wire
spare 103 406
1
2 103
3 243
4 243

80
5 113
6 112
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 6 5 4
12 11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1 3 2 1

Pos. Wire Pos. Wire


1 117 1 spare
2 244 2 spare
3 118 3 spare
4 245 4 spare
5 332 5 113
6 333 6 112
7 407
Pos. Designation Pos. Designation 8 408
9 spare
A3 Base module card S2 Emergency Stop
10 spare
A6 Security control card S3 Base/basket selector 11 spare
F2 15A fuse S5 Turret rotation selector 12 spare
F3 5A fuse S6 Telescope extension / retraction selector 13 spare
H1 Offset LED indicator - red LED S7 Pendular arm up / down selector 14 spare
15 spare
H2 Offset LED indicator - green LED S8 Pendular arm rotation selector
16 spare
H3 Overload warning LED S9 Basket rotation selector 17 spare
H4 Maintenance warning LED S10 Arm 3 up / down selector 18 spare
KA1 Electro-valve supply relays S11 Arm 1/2 up / down selector 19 spare
KA10 Relay S12 Tilt / reverse tilt selector 20 spare
KA11 Relay S23 Dead man’s button 21 spare
22 spare
P2 Timer
23 spare
24 spare
547379EN
96 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLER HARNESS


- ITEM 6

103

A
6 5 4
3 2 1

To
VARIABLE SPEED
Pos. Wire
variable speed drive
1 spare HARNESS
drive board
2 spare 678397 - C
3 127
4 spare Ref. 6
5 113
6 112

B- B
B+ F1 12 11 10 9 8 7
6 5 4 3 2 1
F2
114
R A Pos. Wire
1 106
S 2 119 115
3 117
4 109
5 108 116
6 118
7 107
105
8 102
9 130
10 spare 110
11 121
12 spare
103

113

110
To charger 101

105
4 2 5 112
1 3
100
Pos. Wire Colour
1 115 brown 127
2 Spare
3 116 white
4 Spare 107
5 Spare
Shield. 114 Green
235

117

108
80

To 109
variable speed drive
F1 KM1 fuses board
118
101
KM3 KM2
119
102

106 106

130
106
106
103
121

106
To complete
235 base box
Ref. 5
According to
installation
To right-hand
battery + terminal

132

To battery cut-out
132

100
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 97

ELECTROVALVE HARNESS
ELECTRO-VALVE HARNESS
- ITEM 7 678393 - E
Ref. 4
Pos. Wire Couleur Liaison
2
EV6 - LOWER ARM UP
1 241 Bown
1
2 239 White D OUT 03

2
EV8 - UPPER ARM UP 1 241 Bown
1
2 238 White D OUT 05

2
EV10 - TELESC. EXTENTED 1 241 Bown
1
2 237 White D OUT 13

2
EV12 - PENDULAR ARM UP
1 241 Bown
1
2 236 White D OUT 07

2
EV14 - COMP./TILT UP
1 241 Bown
1
2 231 White D OUT 21

2 1 241 White
1
EV3 - TANK OUTLET
2 262 Bown D OUT 01

2 1 241 Bown
1
EV15 - COMP./TILT DOWN
2 223 White D OUT 14
E

2 1 241 Bown
EV13 - PENDULAR ARM DOWN
B5 A5 1
2 224 White D OUT 06

B4 A4 2 1 241 Bown
EV11 - TELESC. RETRACTED
1
2 225 White D OUT 09
B3 A3
2 1 241 Bown
EV9 - UPPER ARM DOWN
B2 A2
1
2 226 White D OUT 04

2 1 241 Bown
B1 A1 EV7 - LOWER ARM DOWN
1
2 227 White D OUT 02
F
T1
T 2 1 103 White
SQ3 - PRESSURE STAT
1
2 119 Bown

2 1 241 Bown
EV17 - BASKET ROT. LEFT
B6 A6 1
2 222 White D OUT 12

2 1 241 Bown
B7 A7 EV1 - STEERING LEFT
1
2 234 White D OUT 15

B8 A8
2 1 241 Bown
EV19 - TURRET ROT. LEFT
1 2 221 White D OUT 08

80
2 1 241 Bown
EV18 - TURRET ROT. RIGHT
1 2 228 White D OUT 10

2
1 241 Bown
EV5 - STEERING RIGHT
1 2 229 White D OUT 16

2
1 241 Bown
EV16 - BASKET ROT. RIGHT
1 2 230 White D OUT 18

2
1 242 Bown
1 EV2b - BRAKE B 2 233 White

2
1 242 Bown
EV2a - BRAKE A
1 2 233 White

2
1 241 Bown
1
EV22 - RIGHT JIB ROT. 2 220 White D OUT 17

2
1 241 Bown
1
EV23 - LEFT JIB ROT. 2 219 White D OUT 11

To complete
base box
Ref. 5
547379EN
98 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS
- ITEMS 8, 9, 10, 11

Pos. Wire Colour


1 123 Pink
2 103 Dark Blue
6 1 3 244 Black
Wire Colour SENSORS 5 2 4 123 Red
123 Pink CONSOLE OUTPUT 4 3 5 103 Violet
HARNESS 6 117 Orange
103 Dark Blue
678476 - C
244 Black To Arm low sensors bundle
Ref. 11
123 Red (120 AETJL) - Ref. 14
telescope sensors harness
103 Violet
(120 AETJL) - Ref. 12
117 Orange or
123 Yellow To inductive sensors
intermediate harness
103 Green (150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL
245 Grey 170 AETJL
AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49) - Ref. 12
123 Light blue
103 White Pos. Wire Colour
118 Brown 6 1 1 123 Yellow
2 103 Green
5 2
3 245 Grey
4 3
4 123 Light Blue
5 103 White
6 118 Brown

FLASHING LIGHT
To complete base box
Ref. 5
678389 - C To flashing light
Ref. 10 (option)
106

218

Pos. Wire
1 106
1 2 2 218

ALARM
HARNESS
678391 - D
80

Rep. 9
To audible alarm
123

217

Pos. Wire
1 217
1 2 2 123

TILT HARNESS
678392 - D
Ref. 8 To tilt sensor

123

103

109

Pos. Wire
A 103
B
B 123
A
C C 109
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 99

MISCELLANEOUS HARNESS
- ITEMS 12, 13, 14, 15
Installation procedure:
- 120 AETJL
SQ4a
Pin Fil B B Pin Fil
A marron A A 123
A
B bleu C C B 103
C noir C 118

CAPTEURS
INDUCTIF

678901 - A
Rep. 13

SQ4b
Pin Fil
B
A 123
A
C B 103
C 245

FAISCEAU CAPTEURS FAISCEAU


BRAS BAS CAPTEURS
678883 - B TELESCOPE
Rep. 14 678864 - C
Rep. 12

B B
A A
C C

Pin Fil Pin Fil


A 123 A 123

80
B 103 B 103
1 6 1 6
C 244 C 117
SQ1b SQ1a 2 5 2 5
3 4 3 4

Pin Fil Pin Fil


1 123 1 123
B 2 103 2 103
A 3 244
C 3 245
4 123 4 123
5 103 5 103
6 117 6 118
Pin Fil
A marron
B bleu
C noir
Vers Faisceau
pupitre CAPTEURS
678476 - C
Rep. 11

CAPTEURS
INDUCTIF
678901 - A
Rep. 15
547379EN
100 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

- ITEMS 12, 13, 14, 15


Installation procedure:
- 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL - AETJ 43 - AETJ 43 3D - AETJ 49

SQ4a

Pin Fil Pin Fil


B B
A marron A 123
A C A
B bleu C B 103
C noir C 118

CAPTEURS INDUCTIF
678901 - A
Rep. 13

SQ4b

Pin Fil
B A 123
A B 103
C
C 245

FAISCEAU
INTERMEDIAIRE
CAPTEURS
FAISCEAU CAPTEURS INDUCTIFS
BRAS BAS 678475 - C
678396 - C Pin Fil Rep. 12
Rep. 14 1 6 1 123
6 1
2 5 2 103
5 2
3 4 3 244
4 3
4 123
5 103
6 117

B B
C A C A
80

Pin Fil Pin Fil


A 123 A 123
B 103 B 103
C 244 C 117
SQ1b SQ1a

1 6 2 1 1 6
B 2 5 2 5
A 3 4 3 4
C

Pin Fil Pin Fil


Pin Fil
1 123 1 123
A marron
2 103 2 103
B bleu
3 244 3 245
C noir
4 123 4 123
5 103 Vers Faisceau 5 103
6 117 pupitre CAPTEURS 6 118
Rep. 11

CAPTEURS
INDUCTIF
SQ1b
678901
Rep. 15
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 101

80.3 ELECTRICAL CONTROL AND ADJUSTMENT

80.3.1 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER


ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL

80 - 72 - Raise the arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 080 - 72) is raised
by 1 m (39.37 in).
1
-Turn the turret by 1/4 turn (2, 080 - 73)

- Switch off the power supply.

2 - Remove the cover (3, 080 - 74).


4
- Remove the battery protective casings (4, 080 - 72).
3

- Remove the cables connected to the charger from the battery


(680.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL, 5 137)

80 - 73 - Remove the cover plate (1, 080 - 73).


1
- Remove the charger (2, 080 - 73).

80
547379EN
102 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION

80 - 74
EXTERNAL VIEW
1
- Mains power supply cable..................................... (1, 080 - 74)
- LED indicator ............................................... (2, 080 - 74)
- Charging cables ...........................................................(3, 080 - 74)
2
6
- Auxiliary contacts ........................................... (4, 080 - 74)
5 7 - 5-pin plug.................................................... (5, 080 - 74)
4 - Capacity switch protective plug ......... (6, 080 - 74)
- Sticker: indication of settings (position of capacity switch) made
during first installation .................... (7, 080 - 74)
3

NOTE: ignore this sticker when configuring the settings for the
charger (6 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES,
5 104)

80 - 75
INTERNAL VIEW
3

- Input fuse F1 (1, 080 - 75): 20 A (see parts catalog)


2 3
- Output fuse F2 (2, 080 - 75): 45 A (see parts catalog)
6 4

- Fans .............................................................. (3, 080 - 75)

- Battery capacity switch C .......................... (4, 080 - 75)

- Input terminals ........................................................... (5, 080 - 75)

- Output terminals ........................................................... (6, 080 - 77)


80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 103

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS

80 - 76 - Auxiliary contacts to cut-off load movements: internal diagram


(see figure, 080 - 76).

NC C NO NC C NO

AUX 1 AUX 2

80 - 77
- 5-pin plug to connection the removed LED harness: external
2 diagram (see figure, 080 - 77).
5 4
3 1
BROWN
WHITE

GREEN LED RED LED

80
547379EN
104 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES

80 - 78 - Voltage curve:
U
Um

U1

I
- Amperage curve:
Im WUla
I1
IUla

I2

t
T1 T2 T3 STOP

- Properties:

Intensity: lm = 43 A I1 = 36 A I2 = 4% C5
Voltage: U1 = 57.6 V Um = 66 V
Other: C = C5

Type of charger IULa WULa


Ca pac it y switch
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
position
80

Capacity (Ah) 345 315 290 260 230 200 175 145 345 315 290 260 230 200 175 145

I2 (A) 138 127 115 104 92 81 69 58 138 127 115 104 92 81 69 58

Charging time IULa WULa


Capacity switch
0 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 A B C D E F
position
10hr 7hr 6hr 5hr 4hr 10hr 7hr 6hr 5hr 4hr
T1max (h) 45min
10hr 9hr 8hr
15min 15min 30min 30min 45min
10hr 9hr 8hr
15min 15min 30min 30min
T2max (h) 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr 3hr
15hr 12hr 11hr 10hr 9hr 15hr 12hr 11hr 10hr 9hr
(T1+T2+T3)max (h) 45min
15hr 14hr 13hr
15min 15min 30min 30min 45min
15hr 14hr 13hr
15min 15min 30min 30min

CAUTION
The capacity Switch is to be configured based on the battery properties shown on the stick affixed to the battery.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 105

ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATORS

80 - 79 LED charger indicator (see figure, 080 - 79)

- Red permanently on: initial charging phase.


100% - Yellow permanently on: battery at 80% charge.
- Green permanently on: battery at 100% charge.

80% 80% - LED flashing + intermittent audible signal from the charger: alarm
situation (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)
START

80 - 80
LED indicator removed (see figure, 080 - 80)
- Red permanently on: initial charging phase.
- Yellow permanently on: battery at 80% charge.
- Green permanently on: battery at 100% charge.

- LED flashing + intermittent audible signal from the charger: alarm


situation (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)

80
547379EN
106 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.3.2 IES BATTERY CHARGER

IES BATTERY CHARGER REMOVAL


80 - 81

1 - Raise the arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 080 - 81) is raised
by 1 m (39.37 in).

-Turn the turret by 1/4 turn (2, 080 - 81)

2 - Switch off the power supply.


4
- Remove the cover (3, 080 - 81).
3

- Remove the battery protective casings (4, 080 - 81).

- Remove the cables connected to the charger from the battery


(680.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL, 5 137)

80 - 82 - Remove the cover plate (1, 080 - 82).


1
- Remove the charger (2, 080 - 82).

2
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 107

IES BATTERY CHARGER DESCRIPTION


EXTERNAL VIEW
80 - 83
- Charging cables ...........................................................(1, 080 - 83)
- Mains power supply cable..................................... (2, 080 - 83)
- Auxiliary contacts ........................................... (3, 080 - 83)
1
- 5-pin plug.................................................... (4, 080 - 83)

4
2

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS

80 - 84
Auxiliary contacts to cut-off load movements: internal diagram
(see figure, 080 - 84).

NC C NO NC C NO

AUX 1 AUX 2

- 5-pin plug to connection the removed LED harness: external

80
80 - 85
2 diagram (see figure, 080 - 85).
5 4
3 1
BROWN
WHITE

GREEN LED RED LED


547379EN
108 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

IES BATTERY CHARGER CONNECTIONS LOAD CURVES

The charging current is selected automatically.

IES BATTERY CHARGER - INDICATOR

80 - 86 LED indicator removed (see figure, 080 - 86)


1 - Off: charger not powered
- Red permanently on: initial charging phase.
- Yellow permanently on: battery at 80% charge.
- Green permanently on: battery at 100% charge.

- LED flashing:
Yellow: battery balancing cycle
Red: alarm situation (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 109

80.3.3 ELECTRONIC MODULES - CONTROL AND SETTINGS

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS - REMOVAL

80 - 87 Base module control unit + safety control card

- Open the right-hand turret cover (1, 080 - 87).


1
- Open the front face of the base control panel (2, 080 - 87).

80 - 88 - Remove the plate holding the card in place (1, 080 - 88) and
remove the cards:
3
- Safety control card (2, 080 - 88).
2
1
- Base module control unit (3, 080 - 88).

80
80 - 89 Basket module control unit

- Remove the front face from the basket control panel (1, 080 - 89).
1

- Remove the basket module control unit (2, 080 - 89).

2
547379EN
110 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

ELECTRONIC CONTROL UNITS DESCRIPTION AND WIRING


Base module control unit

80 - 90 80 - 91

C-NEG B+2
CAN A-IN D-OUT D-IN

1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
4 5 6 5 6 7 8 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
B+
B-NEG D-NEG

LED RUN :
- ON, control unit powered.
- OFF, control unit switched off, defective or BUS-CAN problem.

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Notactivated Activated
1 243 +12V NOT MEASURABLE
2 0V NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
CAN
4 +12V NOT MEASURABLE
5 113 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
6 112 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
1 Free NOT MEASURABLE
2 Free NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
4 Free NOT MEASURABLE
A-IN
5 Free NOT MEASURABLE
6 Free NOT MEASURABLE
7 Free NOT MEASURABLE
8 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
C-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
D-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
80

1 215 JIB - Right Rotation Measurement to be performed using multimeter 0V


2 214 Arm 1/2 - Raised 2.6.1 Boom 1 up Open Closed 0V
3 213 Arm 1/2 - Lowered 2.6.2 Boom 1 down Open Closed 0V
4 212 Arm 3 - Raised 2.6.3 Boom 2 up Open Closed 0V
5 211 Arm 3 Lowered 2.6.4 Boom 2 down Open Closed 0V
6 208 Turret - Left Rotation 2.6.9 Slew left Open Closed 0V
7 207 Turret - Right Rotation 2.6.10 Slew right Open Closed 0V
8 205 Telescope - Retracted 2.6.7 Tele in Open Closed 0V
D-IN
9 206 Telescope - Extended 2.6.8 Tele out Open Closed 0V
10 201 Tilt - Raised 2.6.12 Cage level forward Open Closed 0V
11 202 Tilt - Lowered 2.6.13 Cage level reverse Open Closed 0V
12 209 Jib - up 2.6.5 Jib up Open Closed 0V
13 210 Jib - down 2.6.6 Jib down Open Closed 0V
14 204 Basket - Left Rotation 2.6.14 Cage rotate left Open Closed 0V
15 203 Basket - Right Rotation 2.6.15 Cage rotate right Open Closed 0V
16 216 JIB - Left Rotation Measurement to be performed using multimeter
B+ 106 +48V bat NOT MEASURABLE
B2+ 106 +48V bat NOT MEASURABLE
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 111

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Notactivated Activated
1 262 Tank return NOT MEASURABLE
2 227 Arm 1/2 - Lowered NOT MEASURABLE
3 239 Arm 1/2 - Raised NOT MEASURABLE
4 226 Arm 3 Lowered NOT MEASURABLE
5 238 Arm 3 - Raised NOT MEASURABLE
6 224 Jib - down NOT MEASURABLE
7 236 Jib - up NOT MEASURABLE
8 221 Turret - Left Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
9 225 Telescope - Extended NOT MEASURABLE
10 228 Turret - Right Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
11 219 JIB - Left Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
12 222 Basket - Left Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
D-OUT
13 237 Telescope - Extended NOT MEASURABLE
14 223 Compensation - Lowered NOT MEASURABLE
15 234 Steering - Left NOT MEASURABLE
16 229 Steering - Right NOT MEASURABLE
17 220 JIB - Right Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
18 230 Basket - Right Rotation NOT MEASURABLE
19 217 Horn NOT MEASURABLE
20 218 Flashing Lights NOT MEASURABLE
21 231 Compensation - Raised NOT MEASURABLE
22 233 Brake NOT MEASURABLE
23 Free NOT MEASURABLE
24 235 Pump NOT MEASURABLE

NOTE: When powered on, the LED flashes once, then switches on or remains off depending on the
results of the test phase.
- The operation of the base and basket fail-safes is checked using input 2.4.5 (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED
CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
- To check the inputs on the base control unit, it is imperative that the fail-safe button is pressed, then
proceed by holding down the movement selector.

80
547379EN
112 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Safety control card

80 - 93 80 - 92

OUT2
CAN B B+

1 2 3 1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
4 5 6 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
OUT1 B-

LED RUN :
ON, control unit powered.
FLASHING, fault on the overload circuit.
OFF, control unit switched off, defective, or BUS-CAN problem.

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN Wire N° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Not activated Activated
1 117 Arm 1/2 down - SQ1a 1.3.11 Boom rest Open Closed 0V (1)
2 244 Arm 1/2 down - SQ1b 1.3.17 Boom rest 2 Open Closed 0V (1)
3 118 Telescope retracted - SQ4a 1.3.12 Tele sw Open Closed 0V (1)
4 245 Telescope retracted - SQ4b 1.3.15 Tele sw 2 Open Closed 0V (1)
5 332 Overload - SQ5a 2.4.9 Cage over see overload _ (2)
6 333 Overload - SQ5b 1.3.16 Cage over 2 see overload _ (2)
7 Free NOT MEASURABLE
8 408 Return to overload validation 1.3.14 SFTY Rel Open Closed 0V (3)
9 Free NOT MEASURABLE
10 Free NOT MEASURABLE
11 Free NOT MEASURABLE
12 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B
13 Free NOT MEASURABLE
14 Free NOT MEASURABLE
15 Free NOT MEASURABLE
16 Free NOT MEASURABLE
17 Free NOT MEASURABLE
18 Free NOT MEASURABLE
19 Free NOT MEASURABLE
20 Free NOT MEASURABLE
80

21 Free NOT MEASURABLE


22 Free NOT MEASURABLE
23 Free NOT MEASURABLE
24 Free NOT MEASURABLE
1 NOT MEASURABLE
2 NOT MEASURABLE
3 NOT MEASURABLE
CAN
4 NOT MEASURABLE
5 112 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
6 113 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
OUT 1 406 Validation overload Ka11 0V
OUT 2 405 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B- 103 0V NOT MEASURABLE
B+ 106 +48V NOT MEASURABLE

1: 0 V in transport position only.


2 : ..............................(680.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 126).
3: Input must be in the “closed” state in order to obtain all movements.

NOTE: When powered on, the LED flashes once, then switches on or remains off depending on the
results of the test phase.
NOTE: There are no parameters for displaying the outputs, measurements must be taken with a multimeter.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 113

Basket module control unit

80 - 94 80 - 95

B+2
CAN A-IN D-OUT D-IN

1 2 3 1 2 3 4 1 12 1 8
4 5 6 5 6 7 8 13 24 9 16

B+

LED RUN :
- ON, control unit powered.
- OFF, control unit switched off, defective or BUS-CAN problem.

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Not activated Activated
1 Free NOT MEASURABLE
2 Free NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
CAN
4 Free NOT MEASURABLE
5 112 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
6 113 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
1 315 Rotation set-point (%) 2.4.3 Y Axis Joystick % _ (1)
Rotation set-point V) 2.4.4 Y Axis Joystick Voltage _ (1)
2 318 Traction set-point (%) 2.4.1 X Axis Joystick % _ (1)
Traction set-point (V) 2.4.2 X Axis Joystick Voltage _ (1)
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
A-IN
4 Free NOT MEASURABLE
5 Free NOT MEASURABLE
6 Free NOT MEASURABLE
7 Free NOT MEASURABLE
8 Free NOT MEASURABLE
B-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
C-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE
D-NEG 103 0V (masse) NOT MEASURABLE

80
1 319 Fail-safe 2.4.5 Deadman Open Closed 0V (9)
2 312 Overload 1 NO NOT MEASURABLE _ (2)
3 311 Travel selection 2.4.10 Traction select Open Closed 0V (3)
4 313 Not neutral 1.3.18 Joystick NTRL sw Open Closed 0V (8)
5 332 Overload SQ5b NF 2.4.9 NOT MEASURABLE
6 316 Steering G 1.3.6 Steer left Open Closed 0V (3)
7 317 Steering D 1.3.7 Steer right Open Closed 0V (3)
8 306 JIB Rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V (3)
D-IN
9 310 Select arm 1/2 2.4.11 Boom 1 select Open Closed 0V (3)
10 309 Select arm 3 2.4.12 Boom 2 select Open Closed 0V (3)
11 304 Telescope selection 2.4.14 Tele select Open Closed 0V (3)
12 303 Jib selection 2.4.13 Jib select Open Closed 0V (3)
13 305 Compensation selection 2.4.16 Cage level select Open Closed 0V (3)
14 308 Basket rotation selection 2.4.17 Cage rotate Open Closed 0V (10)
15 307 Turret rotation selection 2.4.15 Slew select Open Closed 0V (10)
16 302 Horn NOT MEASURABLE 0V (3)
B+ 106 +48V battery NOT MEASURABLE
B2+ 106 +48V battery NOT MEASURABLE
547379EN
114 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Not activated Activated
1 325 Turret rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
2 328 Arm 1/2 NOT MEASURABLE 0V
3 327 Arm 3 NOT MEASURABLE 0V
4 322 Telescope NOT MEASURABLE 0V
5 321 Jib NOT MEASURABLE 0V
6 324 JIB Rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
7 323 Compensation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
8 326 Basket rotation NOT MEASURABLE 0V
9 Free NOT MEASURABLE
10 Free NOT MEASURABLE
11 Free NOT MEASURABLE
12 Free NOT MEASURABLE
D-OUT
13 329 Traveling NOT MEASURABLE 0V
14 331 Alarm/faults NOT MEASURABLE _ (4)
15 320 Buzzer NOT MEASURABLE _ (5)
16 330 Tilt NOT MEASURABLE _ (6)
17 NOT MEASURABLE
18 335 Overload ref. NOT MEASURABLE _ (7)
19 338 Maintenance alarm NOT MEASURABLE 0V
20 NOT MEASURABLE
21 336 Overload NOT MEASURABLE _ (7)
22 338 Tilt ref. NOT MEASURABLE not used
23 Free NOT MEASURABLE
24 Free NOT MEASURABLE

1 - (680.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS, 5 133)


2 - See overload settings (680.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 126)
3 - Keep the selection to measure the signal.
4 - Negative signal (0 V) intermittent: LED overload.
5 - Negative signal (0 V) intermittent if in tilt, continue if overload.
6 - Negative signal (0 V) intermittent (tilt LED + variable speed controller redundancy).
7 - See overload (680.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 126)
8 - Joystick in neutral position if parameter displayed is Open.
Each time the joystick is moved, the parameter turns to Closed.
9 - The operation of the base and basket failsafes is checked using input 2.4.5 (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED
CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
80

10 - Based on the position of the selector at the time of the check.

NOTE:
- When powered on, the LED flashes once, then switches on or remains off depending on the results of
the test phase.

- There are no parameters for displaying the outputs of the basket module control unit, measurements
must be taken with a multimeter.

ELECTRONIC MODULES - DIAGNOSTICS AND SETTINGS


(680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 115

80.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DESCRIPTION


Relay and fuse holder plate
80 - 96
3
- Power contacts:

1
2 - Line contact KM1 (A1-1) - Resistance ............. 46.1 Ω
- Electric pump KM3 (2, 080 - 96) - Resistance ............. 46.1 Ω
- Traction/pump motors KM2 (3, 080 - 96) - Resistance ............. 19.2 Ω

- Free wheel diode (4, 080 - 96) - Resistance ................................... 44 Ω


4
- Fuse of power circuit (4, 080 - 96): 325 A (see parts catalog)

80 - 97
Variable speed controller plate
2

- Variable speed controller (1, 080 - 97).

1 - Electronic module (2, 080 - 97).

- Fuse (3, 080 - 97): 100A (see parts catalog)


3

80
547379EN
116 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - WIRING


Control circuit - Electronic module

80 - 98 80 - 99

A B

1 2 3 1 6
4 5 6 7 12

Base module control unit Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Connector PIN WireN° Signal Type of signal Menu Description Not activated Activated Notactivated Activated
1 128 +10.5V Not used NOT MEASURABLE
2 128 0V NOT MEASURABLE
3 Free NOT MEASURABLE
A
4 +10.5V Not used NOT MEASURABLE
5 113 CAN-L NOT MEASURABLE
6 112 CAN-H NOT MEASURABLE
1 106 Power supply Incoming
2 119 Pressure switch Incoming 1.3.13 Brake release Open Closed +48V
3 117 Arm down SQ1a Incoming 1.3.11 Boom rest Open Closed _ (1)
4 109 Tilt Incoming 1.3.10 Tilt Open Closed 0V (3)
5 108 Base selector Incoming 2.6.11 Lower box select Open Closed 0V (5)
6 118 Telescope retracted SQ4a Incoming 1.3.12 Tele sw Open Closed 0V (2)
B 7 Free
8 102 Line switch Outgoing 0V

9 130 Pump/traction switch Outgoing 0V (4)

10 Free
80

11 121 Switch KM2 Outgoing


12 +12V

1 - See operation of brake release electrical circuit.


2 - 0 V when the base/basket selector is set to base.
3 - 0 V in transport position only.
4 - 0 V only during hydraulic movements (except for travel, left/right steering, and supplying brakes).
5 - See tilt sensor settings for operating conditions (6TILT SENSOR - SETTINGS, 5 126)
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 117

Power circuit

80 - 100

D1

A1
Variable speed
controller plate +

-
F2
+
F1

B+ A

E1 E2 B- S

A2
A1

A1
A2
E1

80
Variable speed controller
E2 plate relay
547379EN
118 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - DIAGNOSTIC AND ADJUSTMENT TOOLS


CALIBRATOR
CAUTION
The calibrator is also used for:
- The adjustment of the switches. (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
- Testing the manipulators. (680.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS, 5 133)
- Troubleshooting. (680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)

80 - 101 Description
1
- Screen (1, 080 - 101).
SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR - Scrolling buttons (2, 080 - 101) (6VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS
2
- USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
- Incrementation buttons (3, 080 - 101) ( 6 VARIABLE SPEED
3 CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
- Connection socket (4, 080 - 101).
Controller A Controller B

4 Menu

Value - +

80 - 102

Fitting

1 - Open the right-hand turret cover (1, 080 - 102).


- Open the front face of the base control panel (2, 080 - 102).
2
- Identify the connection cable and attach to it the connection
socket (4, 080 - 101).
- Switch on the access platform.
- Adjust or check the variable speed controllers (6CONFIGURATION
80

MENUS, 5 121)

80 - 103
DIAGNOSTIC LED

- LED (1, 080 - 103).

- Status of LED and meaning (680.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS,


1
5 73)
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 119

BATTERY CHARGE INDICATOR/HOUR METER

80 - 104
Description

- Screen (1, 080 - 104).


1 - Battery charge indicator (2, 080 - 104).
0% 100%
- Hour meter and variable speed controller fault display screen (3,
2
080 - 104).
Maintenance

h
P
T

3
SEVCON

80 - 105
- Connection socket (1, 080 - 105).

1 2 3
4 5 6
1

Operation (see instruction manual).

Connection

PIN Signal

80
1 Free
2 0V (masse)
3 +12V (back-lit)
4 +12V (power supply)
5 CAN_H
6 CAN_L

Error messages variable speed controller (6 80.1 ELECTRICAL


SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS, 5 73)
547379EN
120 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR

Structure of electronic module menu

- Configuration submenus:
Black text on white background (6CONFIGURATION MENUS, 5 121).
- Test submenus:
White text on black background (6TEST MENUS, 5 124).

SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR

SEVCON 1 Action SEVCON 2 Pump MENU LEVELS


OK OK Choice of menu:
CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR
left/right arrows
Menu validation:
down arrows
SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

2 Pump 2.2 Pump 2.2 Pump


SUB-MENU LEVELS Personalities Status Upper Box Pers

Choice of sub-menu: 4 5 22
PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS

SEVCON
left/right arrows
Validation of sub-menu and access
to list of parameters: CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

down arrows 2.4 Pump 2.5 Pump 2.6 Pump


Return to the menu list: Upper Box Test Lower Box Pers Lower Box Test
up arrows 15 17 15
PARAMETERS PARAMETERS PARAMETERS
SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

1.1 Traction 1.2 Traction 1.3 Traction 1.4 Traction


Personalities Status Test BDI
80

24 16 22 5
PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON PARAMETERS SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

1.5 Traction 1.5 Traction 1.7 Traction 1.8 Traction


Fault Log Setup Motor Setup Display
SEVCON
10 13 6
PARAMETERS PARAMETERS PARAMETERS
CAN CALIBRATOR

SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR

PARAMETERS LEVEL 1.6.1 Trac Setup 1.6.2 Trac Setup 1.6.3 Trac Setup
Choice of parameter: CAN Mode Aboma Chop select On BDI On

SEVCON SEVCON SEVCON
left/right arrows
Modify parameter:

CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR CAN CALIBRATOR
+/- buttons
Return to the list of sub-menus:
up arrows

EXAMPLE
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 121

CONFIGURATION MENUS

Mini Maxi
Menu Traction Personalities Travel parameters Pitch Value
display display
1.1.1A Armature I Max (A) Armature limit current (A) 50 500 10 (*)
1.1.1F Field I Max (A) Field limit current (A) 10 50 1 50
1.1.2 Traction Accel Delay (s) Acceleration curve (s) 0.1 5.0 0.1 1.8
1.1.3 Traction Decel Delay (s) Deceleration curve (s) 0.1 5.0 0.1 0.1
1.1.3A Traction Direction Decel Delay (s) Deceleration curve current (A) 0.1 5.0 0.1 0.8
1.1.4 Traction Creep Speed (%) Zero speed (offset0) (%) 0 25 1 3
Braking regeneration current on flat
1.1.5 Flat Regen Direction Braking (A) 50 500 10 400
(A)

1.1.6 Tilt Regen Direction Braking (A) Braking regeneration current in tilt (A) 50 500 10 500

1.1.7 Traction Regen Time (ms) Recup time (mS) 0 300 10 10


1.1.8 Brake Threshold (V) Threshold voltage (V) 0.09 3.20 0.016 0.8
1.1.9 Traction Maximum Speed (%) Maximum speed (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.10 Elevated Speed (%) Working speed (%) 0 100 1 13
1.1.11 Tilt Speed (%) Tilt speed (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.12 Traction Cut 3 Speed (%) Speed limit 3 (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.13 Review delay (h) Maintenance intervals (H) 0 100 1 50
1.1.14 Customers Options Customizable settings 0 31 1 (+)
1.1.15 Low Speed Traction Speed (%) Slow speed (%) 0 100 1 100
1.1.16 Low Battery Start (V) Low battery safe start (V) 14.5 48.0 0.5 18
1.1.17 Low Battery Cutout (V) Low battery cutout (V) 14.5 48.0 0.5 14.5
1.1.18 High Battery Start (V) High battery safe start (V) 14.5 75.0 0.5 65
1.1.19 High Battery Cutout (V) High battery cutout (V) 14.5 75.0 0.5 70
1.1.20 Battery Protection Level (V) Battery protection (V) 14.5 48.0 0.5 14.5
1.1.21 Battery Protection Delay (s) Battery protection delay (S) 0.1 2.5 0.1 0.5
1.1.22 Traction Alarm Battery alarm ON
(*) According to motor type.
(+) According to Beep option.

Menu Traction BDI Check Battery Charge Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.4.1 BDI Level (%) BDI battery charge level (%) / / / /
1.4.2 BDI Reset Level (V) BDI battery nominal voltage (V) 2.00 2.50 0.01 2.10
1.4.3 BDI Discharge Level (V) BDI Re enclenchement (V) 1.50 1.99 0.01 1.70
1.4.4 BDI Warning Level (%) BDI empty battery (V) 0 90 1 30
1.4.5 BDI Cutout Level (%) BDI Threshold warning (%) 0 90 1 20

80
Menu 1.5 Traction Fault Log Check Fault Log Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value

Menu Traction BDI Check Battery Charge Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.6.1 CAN Mode Configuration of CAN system Aboma

1.6.2 Chop Select Select voltage of digital output codes On

1.6.3 BDI Battery Charge Indicator On


1.6.4 Fault Log Fault log On
1.6.5 Service Log Manage fault log On

1.6.6 EU/US Functionality Select specific functionality Europe/US EU

1.6.7 Traction Full Speed (KPH) Traction Max. Speed (Km/h) 0 160 1 21
1.6.8 Traction Full Speed (MPH) Traction Max. Speed (mph) 0 100 0 13
Select type of accelerator curve
1.6.9 Accelerator Characteristic Centre-Pot
set-point
1.6.10 BDI Battery Voltage (V) Battery rated voltage (V) 24 96 2 48
547379EN
122 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Menu Traction Motor Setup Motor setup Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.7.1 Armature I Low (A) Armature low current (A) 10 240 10 90
1.7.2 Field I Low (A) Field low current (A) 5 25 1 6
1.7.3 Armature I Mid (A) Armature mid current (A) 90 400 10 200
1.7.4 Field I Mid (A) Field mid current (A) 6 40 1 25
1.7.5 Armature I High (A) Armature high current (A) 260 500 10 400
1.7.6 Field I High (A) Field high current (A) 25 50 1 40
1.7.7 Armature Resistance (mOhm) Armature resistance (mOhm) 0 255 1 13
1.7.8 Field Resistance (Ohm) Field resistance (Ohm) 0.25 2.50 0.01 1.26

1.7.9 Drive Proportional Gain Translation proportional gain 0 255 1 2

1.7.10 Drive Integral Gain Travel total gain 0 16 1 6


1.7.11 Brake Proportional Gain Brake proportional gain 0 255 1 40
1.7.12 Brake Integral Gain Brake total gain 0 16 1 15
1.7.13 Speed Estimate Gain Speed estimated gain 0 2.50 0.01 1.5

Menu Traction BDI Check Battery Charge Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
1.8.1 Display Default Hours Select hour meter to display Aboma
1.8.2 Display Status Type Select type of status data to display On

1.8.3 Display Contrast Set contrast level standard display screen 0 127 1 On

Select indicator 1 to display for advanced


1.8.4 FFD Indicator 1 On
display screen
Select indicator 2 to display for advanced
1.8.5 FFD Indicator 2 On
display screen

1.8.6 Display Fault Messages Validate display of default messages EU

Menu Pump Personalities Properties (hydraulic functions) Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
2.1.1 Pump I Max Pump max current (A) 50 500 10 350
2.1.2 Ramp Up Delay Ramp up time (S) 0.1 5.0 0.1 1.8
2.1.3 Ramp Down Delay Ramp down time (S) 0.1 0.5 0.1 0.5
2.1.4 Pump Creep Speed Speed (%) 0 25 1 10
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 123

Menu Pump Upper Box Pers Parameters Hydraulic Functions Average value Time target
Basket codes 120AETJL 150AETL/C 170AETJL 120AETJL 150AETL/C 170AETJL

2.3.1 Boom 1 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 1 & 2 100 17 45


2.3.2 Boom 1 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 1 & 2 42 65 26 45
2.3.3 Boom 1 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 1 & 2 100 100
2.3.4 Boom 2 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 3 telescope extended 73 70 67 24 38 48
2.3.5 Boom 2 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 3 telescope extended 42 38 30 24 34 36
2.3.6 Boom 2 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 3 100 100
2.3.7 Jib Up Speed (%) Speed jib lifting (%) 36 16
2.3.8 Jib Down Speed (%) Jib lowering speed (%) 20 18
2.3.8A Jib Rotate Left Speed (%) Jib left rotation speed (%) 1 1
2.3.8B Jib Rotate Right Speed (%) Jib right rotation speed (%) 1 1
2.3.9 Tele In Speed (%) Speed telescope retraction (%) 100 12 15 17
2.3.10 Tele Out Speed (%) Speed telescope extension (%) 100 24 19 23
2.3.11 Slew Left Speed (%) Speed left rotation turret (%) 29 23 26 80 88 120
2.3.12 Slew Right Speed (%) Speed right rotation turret (%) 29 23 26 80 88 120
2.3.13 Cage Rotate Left Speed (%) Speed left rotation basket (%) 24 7
2.3.14 Cage Rotate Right Speed (%) Speed right rotation basket (%) 24 7
Cage Level Forward Speed
2.3.15 Speed tilting bucket (%) 62 25
(%)
Cage Level Reverse Speed
2.3.16 Speed tilting spill (%) 28 25
(%)
2.3.17 Y-Axis Forward Voltage (V) Front travel voltage (V) 4.06 4.06
2.3.18 Y-Axis Reverse Voltage (V) Rear travel voltage (V) 0.52 0.52
2.3.19 X-Axis Left Voltage (V) Zero position (X-axis) voltage (V) 0.52 0.52
2.3.20 X-Axis Right Voltage (V) Max voltage (X-axis) (V) 4.06 4.06
Speed travel movement over 10 m (s) 100 8
Speed travel working over 10 m (s) 13 60

Menu Pump Lower Box Pers Parameters Hydraulic Functions Base Codes Mini display Maxi display Pitch Value
2.5.1 Boom 1 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 1 & 2 0 100 1 100
2.5.2 Boom 1 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 1 & 2 0 100 1 90
2.5.3 Boom 1 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 1 & 2 0 100 1 100
2.5.4 Boom 2 Up Speed (%) Lifting speed arm 3 telescope extended 0 100 1 100
2.5.5 Boom 2 Down Speed (%) Lowering speed arm 3 telescope extended 0 100 1 70
2.5.6 Boom 2 Cutback Speed (%) Speed limit arm 3 0 100 1 25
2.5.7 Jib Up Speed (%) Speed jib lifting (%) 0 100 1 90
2.5.8 Jib Down Speed (%) Jib lowering speed (%) 0 100 1 75

80
2.5.9 Tele In Speed (%) Speed telescope retraction (%) 0 100 1 100
2.5.10 Tele Out Speed (%) Speed telescope extension (%) 0 100 1 100
2.5.11 Slew Left Speed (%) Speed left rotation turret (%) 0 100 1 60
2.5.12 Slew Right Speed (%) Speed right rotation turret (%) 0 100 1 60
2.5.13 Cage Level Forward Speed (%) Speed left rotation basket (%) 0 100 1 50
2.5.14 Cage Level Reverse Speed (%) Speed right rotation basket (%) 0 100 1 60
2.5.15 Cage Rotate Left Speed (%) Speed tilting bucket (%) 0 100 1 50
2.5.16 Cage Rotate Right Speed (%) Speed tilting spill (%) 0 100 1 50
2.5.17 Overload Cutback Speed (%) Overload speed limit (%) 0 100 1 50
547379EN
124 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

TEST MENUS

Menu Traction Status Status (Variable Speed Controller) Mini display Maxi display Pitch Log. Info
1.2.1 Battery Voltage Battery voltage 0V 127 V 0.1 +
1.2.2 Armature Motor Voltage Armature Voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.3 Field Motor Voltage Field voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.4 Armature Motor Current Armature current 0 625 A 0.20833333 +
1.2.5 Field Motor Current Field current 0 64 A 0.25 +
1.2.6 Armature MOSFET Voltage MOSFET voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.7 Controller Temp. Temperature variable speed controller -30 °C (-22 °F) +225 °C (+437 °F) 1 +–
1.2.8 Capacitor Voltage Capacitor Voltage 0V 127 V 0.5
1.2.9 Speed estimation Speed measurement 0 1 0.005
1.2.10 Speed estimation Speed measurement 0Km/H(0mph) 60Km/H(37.28mph) 1.0
1.2.11 Speed estimation Speed measurement 0 MPH 60 MPH 1.0
1.2.12 Key Switch Hours Count Hour meter operation 0 Hrs 65279.9 Hrs 0.1
Traction Pulsing Hours Count
1.2.13 Hour meter travel 0 Hrs 65279.9 Hrs 0.1
(Drive)
Output,
1.2.14 CAN fail node CAN fault note: 2 None n/a
EOutput
1.2.15 CAN error count CAN meter error - - -
1.2.16 CAN error code CAN coding error - - -
Service Log Reset RAZ memory faults Press + then - to reset Service Log

Menu Traction Test Variable speed controller Mini display Maxi display Pitch Log. Info
1.3.1 Accelerator % Accelerator % 0% 100% 1% range
1.3.2 Accelerator Voltage Accelerator Voltage 0.0 V 5.0 V 0.02 V range
1.3.3 Deadman Fail-safe Open Closed – Switch
1.3.6 Steer left LH steering Open Closed – Switch
1.3.7 Steer Right RH steering Open Closed – Switch
1.3.8 Horn Horn Open Closed – Switch
1.3.9 Traction select Traction select Open Closed – Switch
1.3.10 Tilt Tilt input Open Closed – Switch
1.3.11 Boom Rest Arm down sensor Open Closed – Switch
1.3.12 Tele sw. Extended telescope sensor Open Closed – Switch
1.3.13 Brake Release Brake sensor released Open Closed – Switch
1.3.14 BDI Input BDI Input Open Closed – Switch
1.3.15 Frame Fault Earth detection Open Closed – Switch
1.3.16 Cage Ovl2 Overload detection no. 2 Open Closed – Switch
1.3.18 Joystick NTRL sw Contact joystick not neutral Open Closed – Switch
80

1.3.19 LS Traction sw Select low speed traction Open Closed – Switch


1.3.20 Ver xxxxxxx Software version xxxxxx xxxxxx
1.3.21 Controller Serial Number Variable speed controller serial number 0 99999999 –
1.3.22 Controller type Power type xxnnn –

Menu Pump Status Variable speed controller (hydraulic functions) Mini display Maxi display Pitch Log. Info
2.2.1 Battery Voltage Battery voltage 0V 127 V 0.1 V +
2.2.2 Motor Voltage Motor Voltage 0V 127 V 0.5 V
2.2.3 Motor Current Motor Current 0 625 A 0.20833333 +
2.2.4 MOSFET Voltage MOSFET voltage 0V 127 V 0.5 V
2.2.5 Controller Temp. Microprocessor temperature -30 °C (-22 °F) +225 °C (+437 °F) 1 °C (33.8 °F) +–
Service Log Reset RAZ memory faults Press + then - to reset Service Log
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 125

Menu Pump Upper Box Test Test Hydraulic Functions Basket Codes Mini display Maxi display Pitch Type
2.4.1 Y axis Joystick % Joystick - Y-axis % 0 1 0.01 range
2.4.2 Y axis Joystick Voltage Joystick - Y-Axis Voltage 0.0 V 5.0 V 0.02 V range
2.4.3 X axis Joystick % Joystick - X-axis % 0 1 0.01 range
2.4.4 X axis Joystick Voltage Joystick - X-Axis Voltage 0.0 V 5.0 V 0.02 V range
2.4.5 Deadman Joystick - Deadman pedal Open Closed – Switch
2.4.8 Jib extension Jib detection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.9 Cage over Overload detection no. 1 Open Closed – Switch
2.4.10 Traction select Travel selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.11 Boom 1 Select Select arm 1/2 Open Closed – Switch
2.4.12 Boom 2 Select Select arm 3 Open Closed – Switch
2.4.13 Jib select Jib selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.14 Tele Select Telescope selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.15 Slew Select Turret rotation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.16 Cage Level Select Compensation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.4.17 Cage Rotate Basket rotation selection Open Closed – Switch

Menu Pump Upper Box Test Test Hydraulic Functions Basket Codes Mini display Maxi display Pitch Type
2.6.1 Boom 1 Up Arm 1 Lifting Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.2 Boom 1 Down Arm 1 Lowering Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.3 Boom 2 Up Arm 2 Lifting Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.4 Boom 2 Down Arm 2 Lowering Control Open Closed – Switch
2.6.5 Jib Up Control jib raising Open Closed – Switch
2.6.6 Jib Down Control jib lowering Open Closed – Switch
2.6.7 Tele In Control telescope retraction Open Closed – Switch
2.6.8 Tele Out Control telescope extension Open Closed – Switch
2.6.9 Slew Left Control turret right rotation Open Closed – Switch
2.6.10 Slew Right Control turret left rotation Open Closed – Switch
2.6.11 Lower Box select Selection BASE controls Open Closed – Switch
2.6.12 Cage Level Forward Control forward compensation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.6.13 Cage Level Reverse Control backwards compensation selection Open Closed – Switch
2.6.14 Cage Rotate Left Control turret left rotation Open Closed – Switch
2.6.15 Cage Rotate Right Control turret right rotation Open Closed – Switch

80
547379EN
126 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.3.5 SAFETY COMPONENTS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS


SWITCHES - LOCATION
- (680.2.2 ELECTRICAL POWER COMPONENTS - LOCATION, 5 84)
TILT SENSOR - SETTINGS
CAUTION
The tilt sensors are pre-configured by the manufacturer.
The only parameter that can be adjusted is sensor initialization.

80 - 106 - Place the access platform on level ground and leave the power
switched on.
1
- Open the right-hand turret cover (1, 080 - 106).

- Locate the tilt sensor located between the base control panel
box and the counterweight.

CAUTION
Check that the angle of the sensor written in (2, 080 - 107) matches that of the manufacturer's plate
on the machine.

80 - 107 - Take the disconnected wire (2, 080 - 107) protruding from the
1 2 sensor.
3
- Take off the plastic cap (3, 080 - 107) at the end of the wire.
80

- Remove the right-hand battery protective cover (2, 080 - 107).

- Take an electric wire 0.5 m (19.69 in) long with its ends stripped,
WHITE 0V connect it to the wire (2, 080 - 107) and connect it to the – terminal
BROWN +24 V
YELLOW SIGNAL of the right-hand battery (3, 080 - 106):
Tilt <3° = 0 V
Tilt > 3° = No signal
- The green LED located under the sensor should flash several times.
- It stops when the sensor has initialized.
- It remains continuously lit.

CAUTION
During normal operation, the green LED is lit, and only switches off if the angular tilt value
is exceeded.

Checking
Tilt sensor Measure using the calibrator Authorized movements Multimeter
Audible signal
Tilt LED status Menu Description Message Transport position Working position Signal wire
Travelling Travelling
< 3° Lit None CLOSED 0V
1.3.10 Tilt switch Lifting/lowering Lifting/lowering
> 3° Not lit Intermittent OPEN Travelling None ~V
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 127

ARM DOWN SENSORS - SETTINGS


80 - 108 120 AETJL
-- Set the telescope to the down position, ensuring the control is
activated for as long as necessary, keeping the access platform
switched on.

1
ACCESS PLATFORM 120 AETJL
1 - Loosen the lock nuts (1, 080 - 108).
2 - Screw or unscrew the sensors (2, 080 - 108) until their LED, located
2
next to the power supply wire, switches from off to on (orange);
the clearance remaining between the support and the sensor is
approximately 3 mm (0.11 in).

- Tighten the lock nuts.

80 - 109 ACCESS PLATFORMS 150 AETJC, 150 AETJC 3D, 150 AETJL, 170
AETJL, AETJ 43, AETJ 43 3D, AETJ 49

-Remove the sensor protective covers from arm 3 (1, 080 - 109).
1

80 - 110 - Loosen the lock nuts (1, 080 - 110).

- Screw or unscrew the sensors (2, 080 - 110) until their LED, located
next to the power supply wire, switches from off to on (orange);
the clearance remaining between the support and the sensor is

80
1

1
approximately 3 mm (0.11 in).
2

2
- Tighten the lock nuts.

Checking
Retracted telescope sensor SQ4a Measure using the calibrator Multimeter
Telescope LED status Wire N° Menu Description Message Display
Retracted* Orange 118 Closed 0V
1.3.12 Tele sw
Extended Not lit 118 Open ~V

Retracted telescope sensor SQ4b Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


Telescope LED status Wire N° Menu Description Message Display
Retracted* Orange 245 Closed 0V
1.3.15 Tele sw
Extended Not lit 245 Open ~V
* Access platform in transport position.
547379EN
128 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

BRAKE RELEASE CIRCUIT - CHECKING


CAUTION
The configuration of the pressure switch (1, 080 - 111) is hydraulic and not electrical (670.3.3 BRAKE
RELEASE CIRCUIT - PRESSURE SETTING, 5 48)
This chapter does not deal with verification of the signals.

80 - 111

1 PF

Checking

Pressure switch SQ3 Measure using the calibrator Multimeter

Pressure in braking circuit Wire N° Wire N° Menu Description Message Display

0 to 25 bar* (0 to 362.59 psi) 119 119 Open ~V


1.3.13 Brake release
> 25 bar* (362.59 psi) 119 119 Closed 0V

* Based on pressure switch setting.

NOTE: in the absence of a signal from the brakes pressure switch (parameter 1.3.13 = open), the
electric pump is permanently active = incorrect operation of the access platform due to excess power
consumption of the batteries.
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 129

OVERLOAD SENSORS - SETTINGS

80 - 112
PROCEDURE

- Set the basket to the low position, keeping the access platform
switched on.
2

- Remove the cover (1, 080 - 112).

1 - Connect the calibrator to the access platform (680.3.4 VARIABLE


SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)

Overload spring pre-tensioning adjustment

- Place a load in the basket and distribute it evenly across the floor.
80 - 113
33 - 120 AETJL : 170 kg (375 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - AETJ43 - AETJ 43 3D : 170 kg (375 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL : 200 kg (441 lbs)
33 - 170 AETJL : 170 kg (375 lbs)
1 1

2 2
- Tighten the bolt (2, 080 - 112) in such a way that it remains free
to rotate at the end of the operation with minimum play.
3 3
Overload sensor adjustment

- Undo the lock nuts (1, 080 - 113) then tighten the overload screws
(2, 080 - 113) to their maximum extent.

- Place a load in the basket and distribute it evenly across the floor.
33 - 120 AETJL: 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D : 230 kg (507 lbs)
33 - 150 AETJL: 250 kg (551 lbs)

80
33 - 170 AETJL - AETJ 49: 230 kg (507 lbs)

- Sensor SQ5a: test menu 1.3.16


- Sensor SQ5b: test menu 2.4.9

- Identify sensor SQ5a (yellow ring on the power cable) and loosen
the overload screw (2, 080 - 113) until the calibrator displays OPEN
instead of CLOSED.
- Identify sensor SQ5b (yellow ring on the power cable) and loosen
the overload screw (2, 080 - 113) until the calibrator displays CLOSED
instead of OPEN.
547379EN
130 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Overload test

- Of the load still in the basket, take out 20 kg (44 lbs) and check that:

- The alarm switches off.


- The calibrator displays CLOSED in test menu 1.3.16 (SQ5a).
- The calibrator displays OPEN in test menu 2.4.9 (SQ5b).
- Replace the 20 kg (44 lbs), the alarm triggers (permanent tone), tighten the lock nuts (1, 080 - 113)
and put a paint mark on them to confirm the configuration.
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 131

SIMPLIFIED OVERLOAD WIRING DIAGRAM

Module Controle capt. sec.


Part N° 662/13124
Réf. CI678453

A5 : CAN-L
A6 : CAN-H

B+

B-

B02 : bras_bas_SQ1b
B01 : bras_bas_SQ1a
B03 : tel_rentré_SQ4a
B04 : tel_rentré_SQ4b
332 B05 : surcharge SQ5b
333 B06 : surcharge SQ5a
B07 : retour réduction vitesse
408 B06 : retour validation surcharge

Out_2 : retour vitesse


406 Out_1 : validation surcharge

(+ soft dédié)

MODULE CAN HIGH IO (Upper box)


Part N° 662/13130
Réf. CI677628 CAN6 : CAN-L
CAN5 : CAN-H

Di 16 : klaxon
Di 12 : sélection pendulaire
Di 11 : sélection télescope
Di 13 : sélection compensation
Di 08 : rot. JIB
Di 15 : rot. tourelle B+
Di 14 : rot. panier B+2
Di 10 : sélection bras 3 B/NEG
Di 09 : sélection bras 1/2 C/NEG
Di 03 : sélection translation D/NEG
332 Di 05 : surcharge SQ5a (circuit fermé)
Di 02 : libre 336
surcharge : Do 21
alarme maint. : Do 19
14 34 buzzer : Do 15
pendulaire : Do 05
SQ5b télescope : Do 04
compensation : Do 07
SQ5a 11 31 rot. JIB : Do 06
rot. tourelle : Do 01
Alimentation

80
Ai 01 : consigne rotation rot. panier : Do 08
des électrovannes bras 3 : Do 03
Di 06 : direction GH
Di 07 : direction DR bras 1/2 : Do 02
Ai 02 : consigne traction translation : Do 13
devers : Do 16
Di 01 : Homme mort
alarme/defauts : Do 14 331
Di 04 : Hors NEUTRE
Ref. surcharge : Do 18 335
Ref. devers : Do 22
241 A4

KA1

242

KA11 KA11 KA11

106 +48V
+48V
103
0V
0V
KA1 - Alimentation SQ5a/b - Capteurs H3 - Led H18 - Led
+48V des de surcharge surchage base surcharge panier
électrovannes
547379EN
132 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

OVERLOAD SIGNAL

- The reference of the overload signal is emitted by the basket card, output Do 18 (wire 335)................
(680.1 ELECTRICAL SCHEMATIC DIAGRAMS, 5 73)

U(V) 24V

Multimeter
reading
0.6V
t(s)

1s 1s
5s 5s

Calibrator OPEN OPEN


reading CLOSED CLOSED

MULTIMETER TEST

Overload sensor SQ5a Measure using the calibrator Multimeter


80

Weight in the basket Wire N° Menu Description Message To card Display

< 200 kg (441 lbs) 333 (F4) Safety (F4)


1.3.16 Cage Ovl 2
> 200 kg (441 lbs) 333 Open Safety No signal

Overload sensor SQ5b Measure using the calibrator Multimeter

Weight in the basket Wire N° Menu Description Message To card Display

< 200 kg (441 lbs) 332 (F4) Safety (F4)


2.4.9 Cage Ovl 2
> 200 kg (441 lbs) 332 Open Safety No signal
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 133

80.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS

MANIPULATOR - TESTS USING CALIBRATOR

CAUTION
The manipulator test from the basket base requires the presence of two operators.

- Connect the calibrator to the access platform and display test


80 - 114 menu 2-4 (6 80.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND
3
SETTINGS, 5 115)
2
- Switch on the access platform.
1

- Climb into the basket, then perform the following actions:

- Move the manipulator (1, 080 - 114) forwards and then backwards
without operating the trigger (2, 080 - 114).

- Press the upper left-hand button then the upper right-hand


button (3, 080 - 114) without operating the trigger.

- Operate the trigger (2, 080 - 114) on its own.

- For each action, check on the sub-menu in question the status of


the inputs/outputs at the neutral point, then when the manipulators
or switches are operated.

TEST

- Lastly, select menu 2-4-1 and 2-4-3 (UPPER BOX TEST) on the calibrator and check:

80
- That the proportional signal progresses steadily (i.e. from 0 to 100%).
- That it is at 0% in neutral and 100% only when the manipulator almost reaches its limit.

Manipulator test when lifting/lowering and travelling (Y)


Calibrator (measurement) Position of Joystick
Menu Description Front* Neutral Rear*
2.4.1 Y-axis voltage % 100 0 100
2.4.2 Y Axis joystick voltage 45 25 5
1.3.1 Accelerator % 100 0 100
1.3.2 Accelerator Voltage 45 25 5

* Manipulateur au maximum

Manipulator test with turret/basket rotation (X)


Calibrator (measurement) Position of Joystick
Menu Description Left* Neutral Right*
2.4.3 X Axis Joystick % 100 0 100
2.4.4 X Axis Joystick Voltage 0.5 2.5 4.5

* Manipulateur au maximum
547379EN
134 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

MANIPULATOR - TEST WITH A VOLTMETER

80 - 115
- Climb into the access platform with a voltmeter.

- Remove the front face from the basket control panel (1, 080 - 115)
1
and replace it.

- Locate the colored wires at the manipulator connector (see figure,


080 - 116).

- Take voltage measurements using the pins of the voltmeter,


placing them in contact with the clips crimped to each colored
wire at the manipulator connector.

80 - 116
OLD NEW
STANDARD STANDARD
GREEN GREEN (NOT NEUTRAL - MANIPULATOR)
YELLOW (X) YELLOW (X) (TURRET ROTATION CONTROL)
BLUE YELLOW/BLACK (LH STEERING PB)
BLACK GRAY/BLACK (RH STEERING PB)
GRAY (Y) GRAY (Y) (TRAVEL CONTROL)
PURPLE GREEN/BLACK (DEADMAN TRIGGER)
RED BROWN/BLACK (POWER SUPPLY - TRIGGER)
PINK WHITE/BLACK (POWER SUPPLY - STEERING PB)
Y 0V BROWN BROWN (GROUND)
X +24V WHITE WHITE (+ BATTERY)

Testing the analog outputs


- Move the manipulator (1, 080 - 114) forwards and then backwards without operating the trigger (2,
080 - 114) and check the values displayed by the voltmeter (see figure, 080 - 117).

80 - 117
80

Manipulator towards the LEFT Manipulator towards the


Turret rotation towards the LEFT FRONT - FORWARD
0V
Y
+24V 3W +48V

63V - 470µf
0.5V YELLOW (X) 4.5V GRAY (Y)
0 V BROWN
0 V BROWN

2.5 V YELLOW (X)22.22


2.5 V GRAY (Y)
0 V BROWN

NEUTRAL
0.5 V GRAY (Y) 4.5V ELLOW (X)
0 V BROWN
0 V BROWN

Manipulator towards the Manipulator towards the RIGHT


BACK - REVERSE Turret rotates right
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 135

Testing the logic outputs

- Press the top left-hand button followed by the top right-hand button (3, 080 - 114) without activating
the trigger, and check the values displayed by the voltmeter (see figure, 080 - 118).

80 - 118

ANCIENNE NOUVELLE
A. N. A. N. NORME NORME A. N. A. N.

24V Bl (D) J/N V BLEU (D) JAUNE/NOIR V Bl (D) J/N


V N (G) G/N V NOIR (G) GRIS/NOIR 24V N (G) G/N
R B/M ROUGE BLANC/MARRON R B/M
Ro B/N ROSE BLANC/NOIR Ro B/N
24V B B 24V BLANC BLANC 24V B B

Direction GAUCHE NEUTRE Direction DROITE

- Activate the trigger (2, 080 - 114) only alone and check the values displayed by the voltmeter (see
figure, 080 - 119).

80 - 119

ANCIENNE NOUVELLE ANCIENNE NOUVELLE


NORME NORME NORME NORME

V VIOLET VERT/NOIR 24V VIOLET VERT/NOIR


ROUGE BLANC/MARRON ROUGE BLANC/MARRON
ROSE BLANC/NOIR ROSE BLANC/NOIR
0V BLANC BLANC 0V BLANC BLANC

80
Gachette au NEUTRE Gachette ACTIONNEE

CAUTION
The “V”s mean that an uncertain voltage can be measured on the wire indicated.
“NS” means that there is no signal on the wire indicated”.
547379EN
136 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.4 ELECTRICITY REMOVALS - REFITTING

80.4.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - REMOVAL


80 - 120
- Raise arm 1/2 so that the upper hinge (1, 080 - 120) is raised by
1
1 m (39.37 in).

-Turn the turret by 1/4 turn (2, 080 - 120).

- Switch off the power supply.


2
- Disconnect the right-hand battery:
3

4 - Remove the right-hand battery protective cover (4, 080 - 120).


- Disconnect the - earth (1, 080 - 121).
- Disconnect the + (2, 080 - 121).

80 - 121
- Disconnect the left-hand battery, following the same procedure.

- Remove the cover (4, 080 - 120).

1
2

80 - 122 - Remove the cover plate (1, 080 - 122).


1
80

- Mark and then remove the harnesses connected to the variable


speed controllers (2, 080 - 122) (680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS
- CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)
2

- Remove the variable speed controllers.

2
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 137

80.4.2 BATTERIES - REMOVAL


80 - 123
- Disconnect the right-hand battery:
1

- Remove the right-hand battery protective cover (1, 080 - 123).


- Disconnect the - earth (2, 080 - 123).
2 - Disconnect the + (3, 080 - 123).
3
- Disconnect the left-hand battery, following the same procedure.

80 - 124
- Remove the right-hand battery (see figure, 080 - 124), then the
left-hand battery:

33 - 120 AETJL : 220 kg (485 lbs)


33 - 150 AETJC - 150 AETJC 3D - 150 AETJL - 170 AETJL : 265 kg
(584 lbs)
33 - AETJ 43 - AETJ43 3D : 268 kg (591 lbs)

80
547379EN
138 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.4.3 ELECTRICAL HARNESSES - REMOVAL

A - Wiring based on the schematic diagrams (680.1.3 SCHEMATIC DIAGRAM - BASKET CONTROL PART - 1ST
VERSION, 5 77)

CAUTION
In this chapter, all of the connectors are shown on the wire insertion side.
80
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 139

80.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL

80.5.1 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - FAULTS AND FIXES

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
Lit OK Traction operational and OK. No action required.
F05003 Internal Fault Variable speed controller Variable speed controller needs replacing.
F05004 12V Supply unusable.
Low
F05011 Drive 0 on
F05012 Drive 1 on
F05013 Drive 0 off
F05014 Drive 1 off
F05019 Stack
Corrupted
No message No power to variable speed - Check:
Not lit controller. • Battery voltage.
• Electrolyte-specific gravity by elements.
• The wiring of the batteries, polarities, and tightening of the terminals.
• The fuses.
• The emergency shutdowns.
• The battery cut-off.
• That the battery charger is not connected to the mains.
- Check:
• The battery connections (B-).
• The presence of the “+” battery on the “B1” input of the variable
speed controller logic (+24 V).
• The presence of the “+12 V” output of the B12 pin of the variable
speed controller: availability “+12 V” internal (pre-set).
1 Flash F04012 Pers Error Parameter outside valid range. The - Search for and fix the parameter where the following value is displayed
fault is removed by adjusting the “- - -”.
PARAMETERS value using the calibrator. - Switch the variable speed controller off and on: check the parameters.

F04013 CRC Error Checksum parameter value - Check: the value of all parameters.
incorrect. The fault is removed - Force the update of the CRC by changing any parameter.
by adjusting the value using the - Switch the variable speed controller off and on: check the parameters.
calibrator.
F05001 EEPROM Fault Parameters memory fault. - Check the value of the parameters.
2 Flashs F04003 Sequence Input(s) active when powered on: - Check that the input(s) are in the “CLOSED” status when switched on

80
Fault status “CLOSED”. in the following menus:
INCORRECT • Traction test (1.3).
INPUT • Upper box test (2.4).
SEQUENCE • Lower box test (2.6).
- Check the input(s) which are in error.
F04005 SRO Fault Sequence error: non-compliance - Re-start the start-up procedure for the required movement.
with the start-up procedure.
Sequence Variable speed controller internal - Measure the voltages on the “D-IN” connector inputs of the electronic
Fault or external fault. control units and “B” of the variable speed controller:
or • 0 V = Contact CLOSED.
SRO Fault • > (greater) than 4.5 V = Contact OPEN.
547379EN
140 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
3 Flashs F05009 PUp Trac MOS Failure of power test when - Check the following points:
switching on. • With the line switch (KM1) CLOSED, the voltage at terminal “A” of
MOSFET the variable speed controller must be equal to the battery voltage
(if no movement activated).
• With the line switch (KM1) OPEN, the voltage at terminal “A” of the
variable speed controller is around 7-8 V.

1 - If one of the two points above is correct, the problem originates


outside the variable speed controller. In this case, perform the following
checks (list not exhaustive):
• No negative voltage on the chassis.
• The electric pump must be isolated from the chassis.
• The electrical power harnesses must not be in short circuit.
2 - If any of the points described above is not proven, the
problem originates inside the variable speed controller. In this
case, perform the following checks.

2 - 1 - With the line switch (KM1) CLOSED, the voltage at terminal “A”
of the variable speed controller is <3 V:
• Disconnect the travel motor cables (terminal A, S F1 & F2 on the
variable speed controller).
• Switch the variable speed controller off and on.
• Check if the problem persists.
• Disconnect connector ‘B’ of the variable speed controller logic
module, connect a wire from plug “B1” of the variable speed
controller logic module to a positive battery.
• Switch the variable speed controller off and on.
• Check the status of the LED: if the problem persists, change the
variable speed controller or otherwise check the insulation of the
variable speed controller and the switch (KM3).

2 - 2 - With the line switch (KM1) OPEN, the voltage at terminal “A” of
the variable speed controller is <3 V:
• Internal fault in the variable speed controller, replace it.
F05006 Mosfet s/c Failure of power test - Turn off the machine: if the problem persists, repeat the procedure
when switching on described above
4 Flashs F05008 PUp Trac Weld Line switch (KM1)
- Check if the line switch (KM1) is OPEN when the power supply is cut:
“CLOSED” (stuck or welded) when
SWITCH OPEN
• KM1 OPEN: variable speed controller OK.
switched on: the variable speed
OR CLOSED • KM1 CLOSED: switch stuck, check the switch, check its power
controller measures a voltage on
supply and replace if necessary.
terminal “A” 2 volts less than the
- Check that there is a delay of 2 seconds between switching on and
battery’s rated voltage.
the closure of the line switch (KM1).
• DELAY = 2s: variable speed controller OK.
• Delay ≠ 2s: variable speed controller defective, driver of LINE
switch out of service.
80

- Check the power cables.

F05020 Line Cont O/C Line switch (KM1) - Check:


“OPEN”: the variable speed • The mechanical condition of the switch.
controller measures a voltage on • The coil of the switch.
terminal “A” 3 volts less than the • The control of the switch coil.
battery’s rated voltage. • The power and auxiliary fuses.
• The wiring of the motors.
- Check output B8 of the variable speed controller logic module, the
signal is negative, if this is not the case, the line switch driver is out of
service: change the variable speed controller.
F05021 Coil s/c (std) Digital output in short circuit on - Check:
the E/S module: BASE • The wiring.
• The elements controlled by the module.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 141

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
5 Flashs C_OVL Ssr Flt This fault is detected when there is - Check:
a fault on the overload sensors. • The status of the overload circuits.
FAULTS • The electrical circuit and connections.
SENSORS • Basket electronic control unit and safety electronic control unit.
F02004 C_OVL Sync This fault is detected when the - Check:
Flt two overload sensors are not in • The status of the sensors: parameters: 1.3.16 and 2.4.9.
the same status. • The overload settings.
• The electronic control unit and connections of the sensors.
• Basket electronic control unit and safety electronic control unit.
F02005 ElvTd Ssr Fault Signals an inconsistency between - Check:
the “working/travel” position • The settings of the “Working/Travel” position sensors.
sensors (telescope or arm 2/3). • The correct operation of the sensors.
• The electronic control unit and connections of the sensors.
• Logic module of the variable speed controller and safety
electronic control unit.

F05010 Bypass pump Fault switch KM3 stuck - Check KM3 switch
6 Flashs F02001 Accel. Fault Voltage fault in the joystick on one - Check:
of the X or Y axes. • That the joystick is activated when switched on.
ACCELERATOR Accelerator Value >20% on start- • The joystick supply voltage.
up for one of the X or Y axes. • The values of the manipulator parameters for each of the X and
Y axes.
• The configuration of the joystick potentiometer values.
• That the gray (Y) and yellow (X) harnesses of the joystick and
their connections are in good condition.
F02000 Accel. Fault Accelerator fault (out of range). - Check the manipulator, its wiring.
7 Flashs F04010 Battery High Battery voltage high - Check the correct operation of the battery charger.
on “High V cut” parameter.
VOLTAGE F04009 Battery Low Battery voltage higher than the - Check:
BATTERY “High V cut” parameter. • The state of the battery charge (voltage, electrolyte density, water
Battery voltage lower than the level).
“Low V cut” parameter. • The correct operation of the battery charger, its connectors.
Battery voltage lower than the - Put the access platform on charge.
“battery protection” parameter,
beyond the delay specified by the
parameter “protection delay”.
F01004 BDI Cutout Battery charge level lower than - Check:
“BDI CUTOUT” parameter. • The battery electrolyte-specific gravity.
• The condition of the battery cables.
• The tightening of the cable terminals.
• The BDI parameters.
- Put the access platform on charge.
8 Flashs F01005 Thermal The temperature of the power unit - Check:
Cutback is higher than 75°C (167 °F). • The operating conditions (motor overload, etc.).

80
TEMPERATURE • The tightening of the power terminals (motor, battery).
• The fitting of the variable speed controller plate on the chassis
(heat-conducting grease, etc.).
- Leave the variable speed controller to cool
9 Flashs F05000 Coil s/c The intensity of the current is - Check the current limit on the following digital inputs and outputs:
higher than the acceptable limit • 2A for the connector outputs of the variable speed controller
COIL for one of the following outputs: logic module (Plug 8 and 9 of connector B).
SWITCH - Coil of switch KM1. • 2A for the outputs of the connector “D-OUT” of the CAN
- Relay. electronic control unit of the BASE.
- Electrovalves. • 2A & 100 mA for the outputs of the connector “D-OUT” of the
- LEDs. CAN electronic control unit of the BASKET.
- Buzzer.
- Harnesses.
F05022 Coil s/c (ext) Digital output in short circuit on - Check:
the E/S module: BASKET • The wiring.
• The elements controlled by the module.
547379EN
142 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

Led Message Message Description and


Variable Speed Investigations
Controller Hour meter Calibrator Comments
12 Flashs F05005 Can Bus Fault There is no dialog between one or - Check for each of the electronic control units if their LED is
CANBUS more electronic control units. permanently on:
• If all of the LEDs are lit: perform tests §1-1 and §1-2.
• If at least one LED is switched off: perform test §2.

1-1 Tests to be performed 5 BUS-CAN connectors connected.


- Access platform switched on: measure the voltage between the
BUS-CAN wires and the negative (wire 103).

Theoretical voltage The signal must be


BUS-CAN wire
(V) between
112 ~2.4V 2.3V < < 2.7V
113 ~2.6V 2.3V < < 2.7V
- Access platform switched off: measure the resistance of the BUS-CAN
circuit between wires 112 and 113 at the diagnostics plug:
• The resistance is 95 Ω.

Theoretical resistance
Disconnect successively
between wires 112/113
Smart view 118 Ω
Base control unit 156 Ω
Safety control unit 235 Ω
Variable speed controller 470 Ω
Basket control unit ---
- Access platform switched off: for each of the electronic control
units, measure the resistance between the 112 and 113 inputs
at the CAN connector:
• The resistance is 470 Ω.

1-2 Tests to be performed 5 BUS-CAN connectors disconnected.


- Disconnect the BUS-CAN harnesses (wires 113 and 112) at each
end (variable speed controller, base electronic control unit, basket
electronic control unit).
- For wires 113 and 112, check the continuity between each of them and
each end: check that there is no continuity between wires 113 and 112.
- Check the connections, the shielding (variable speed controller
section - BASE box).
- Put the contact bomb on the BUS-CAN connections, bypass the
BUS-CAN lines with external wires to determine if the wires or
connections are defective.

2-Test to be performed if at least one LED is switched off


- Check when switched off if the LED flashes for 0.5 seconds:
80

• Check the power supply between terminals B+, B+2 (positive


terminals) and B/NEG, C/NEG, D/NEG (negative terminals) of the
control unit which is causing the problem.
• Check the connections of all power supplies mentioned above
- Check the quality of the battery negative signal: wire no. 103.
• Ensure that all of the connections of wire 103 are correctly
attached and connected (crimping of wires not damaged, quality
of contacts, etc.) in the electrical sockets, the terminal blocks, the
terminals, etc.
- Check the quality of the battery positive signal: wire no. 106.
• Ensure that all of the connections of wire 106 are correctly
attached and connected (crimping of wires not damaged, quality
of contacts, etc.) in the electrical sockets, the terminal blocks, the
terminals, etc.
547379EN
80 (08/03/2017) ELECTRICITY 143

80.5.2 ZIVAN BATTERY CHARGER - ERROR SIGNALS

SYMPTOMS CAUSES TO BE DONE IMMEDIATELY CAUSES TO CHECK


Output fuse and if the battery has
Acoustic signal + Battery disconnected or not Check the connection or the rated
been connected with the correct
RED LED flashing compliant. voltage.
polarities
Temperature probe disconnected Check the connection of the The voltage on the temperature
Acoustic signal +
during recharging or out of probe and measure the battery probe and measure the
YELLOW LED flashing
operational range. temperature. temperature of the battery.
Does the charge curve for the
Acoustic signal + Phase 1 and/or Phase 2 more than
Check the capacity of the battery. battery comply with that of the
GREEN LED flashing the maximum permitted.
battery charger?
Acoustic signal +
Loss of control of output current Logic control unit fault. Stage of reading current or shunt.
RED-YELLOW LED flashing
Stage of reading voltage or
Acoustic signal + Battery disconnected or fault on
Loss of control of output voltage resistance of reading voltage of
RED-YELLOW LED flashing logic control unit.
open battery.
Acoustic signal + An unavailable configuration has
Check the position of the selector.
YELLOW-GREEN LED flashing been selected.
Operation of the fan, fan pilot
Acoustic signal + Check the operation of the
Over-heating of semi-conductors. circuit, good connections with PTC
RED-YELLOW-GREEN LED flashing ventilation system.
sensor.

80.5.3 IES BATTERY CHARGER

SYMPTOMS CAUSES TO BE DONE IMMEDIATELY CAUSES TO CHECK


Battery temperature high Ambient temperature > 65°C
Disconnect the charger from the
Battery element in short circuit
mains Battery condition
RED LED flashing Power supply connector
Mains voltage
Disconnect/Reconnect the charger Select the voltages on the charger
Charge cycle greater than 20 hours
to the mains Charger defective

80
547379EN
144 ELECTRICITY 80 (08/03/2017)

80.6 SPECIFIC TOOLING - ELECTRICITY

80.6.1 CALIBRATOR

CAUTION
The calibrator is also used for:
- The adjustment of the switches.
(680.3.4 VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS - CONTROL AND SETTINGS, 5 115)131
- Testing the manipulators.
(680.3.6 MANIPULATOR - OPERATION AND SETTINGS, 5 133)138
- Troubleshooting.
(680.5 TROUBLESHOOTING - ELECTRICAL, 5 139)160

80 - 125 DESCRIPTION
SEVCON 1
- Screen (1, 080 - 125).
CAN CALIBRATOR
- Scrolling buttons (2, 080 - 125) (6VARIABLE SPEED CONTROLLERS
2 - USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
- Incrementation buttons (3, 080 - 125) ( 6 VARIABLE SPEED
3
Controller A Controller B
CONTROLLERS - USE OF CALIBRATOR, 5 120)
4 Menu

Value - +
- Connection socket (4, 080 - 125).
80

Das könnte Ihnen auch gefallen